embOS/IP CPU independant TCP/IP stack for embedded applications User & Reference Guide Document: UM07001 Software version: 2.20 Revision: 0 Date: April 30, 2014 A product of SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG www.segger.com 2 Disclaimer Specifications written in this document are believed to be accurate, but are not guaranteed to be entirely free of error. The information in this manual is subject to change for functional or performance improvements without notice. Please make sure your manual is the latest edition. While the information herein is assumed to be accurate, SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG (SEGGER) assumes no responsibility for any errors or omissions. SEGGER makes and you receive no warranties or conditions, express, implied, statutory or in any communication with you. SEGGER specifically disclaims any implied warranty of merchantability or fitness for a particular purpose. Copyright notice You may not extract portions of this manual or modify the PDF file in any way without the prior written permission of SEGGER. The software described in this document is furnished under a license and may only be used or copied in accordance with the terms of such a license. (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG, Hilden / Germany Trademarks Names mentioned in this manual may be trademarks of their respective companies. Brand and product names are trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective holders. Contact address SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG In den Weiden 11 D-40721 Hilden Germany Tel.+49 2103-2878-0 Fax.+49 2103-2878-28 E-mail: support@segger.com Internet: http://www.segger.com UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 3 Manual versions This manual describes the current software version. If any error occurs, inform us and we will try to assist you as soon as possible. Contact us for further information on topics or routines not yet specified. Print date: April 30, 2014 Software Revision Date By Description 2.20 0 140430 Chapter "Core functions" updated. * IP_ConfigOffCached2Uncached() added. * IP_AddLoopbackInterface() added. * IP_AddStateChangeHook() added. * IP_Alloc() added. * IP_ARP_ConfigMaxPending() added. * IP_Connect() added. * IP_DisableIPRxChecksum() added. * IP_Disconnect() added. * IP_DNS_SetServerEx() added. * IP_EnableIPRxChecksum() added. * IP_Err2Str() added. * IP_Free() added. * IP_GetPrimaryIFace() added. * IP_IsExpired() added. * IP_ResolveHost() added. * IP_SetIFaceConnectHook() added. * IP_SetIFaceDisconnectHook() added. * IP_SetPrimaryIFace() added. * IP_SOCKET_ConfigSelectMultiplicator() added. * IP_ICMP_DisableRxChecksum() added. * IP_ICMP_EnableRxChecksum() added. * IP_TCP_DisableRxChecksum() added. * IP_TCP_EnableRxChecksum() added. * IP_UDP_DisableRxChecksum() added. * IP_UDP_EnableRxChecksum() added. OO * IP_ConfTCPSpace() renamed to IP_ConfigTCPSpace() Chapter "Socket interface" updated. * gethostbaname() parameter changed to "const char *" for standard BSD socket compatibility. Chapter "UDP zero-copy interface" updated. * IP_UDP_GetDestAddr() added. * IP_UDP_GetIFIndex() added. * IP_UDP_GetSrcAddr() added. Chapter "RAW zero-copy interface" updated. * IP_RAW_GetDataSize() added. * IP_RAW_GetDestAddr() added. * IP_RAW_GetIFIndex() added. Chapter "DHCP client" updated. * IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnActivate() added. * IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnFail() added. * IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnLinkDown() added. * IP_DHCPC_Renew() added. Chapter "PPP / PPPoE (Add-on)" updated. * IP_PPP_OnTxChar() return value changed. Chapter "Appendix A - File system application layer" updated. * pfIsFolder added to IP_FS_API structure. * pfMove added to IP_FS_API structure. Chapter "DHCP server (Add-on)" added. Chapter "Performance & resource usage" updated. * Values for ROM & RAM usage updated. Minor changes. 2.12g 0 131216 OO Chapter "Core functions" updated. * IP_ConfigOffCached2Uncached() added. 2.12f 0 130909 OO Chapter "Core functions" updated. * IP_AddAfterInitHook() added. Chapter "UDP zero-copy interface" updated. * IP_UDP_GetDataSize() added. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 4 Software Revision Date By Description 2.12c 0 130515 Chapter "Introduction to embOS/IP" updated. * Added information regarding task priorities. Chapter "Core functions" updated. * Added extended information to IP_DeInit() description. OO Chapter "Web server (Add-on)" updated. * IP_WEBS_GetURI() added. * IP_WEBS_Reset() added. 2.12b 0 130419 OO 130312 Minor updates and corrections. Chapter "Core functions" updated. * IP_PHY_DisableCheck() added. * IP_RAW_Add() added. * IP_DNS_GetServer() added. * IP_DNS_GetServerEx() added. Chapter "Socket interface" updated. * Information regarding usage of RAW sockets added. OO Chapter "Web server (Add-on)" updated. * IP_WEBS_AddVFileHook() updated. * IP_WEBS_Redirect() added. * IP_WEBS_StoreUserContext() added. * IP_WEBS_RetrieveUserContext() added. * IP_WEBS_GetDecodedStrLen() added. * IP_WEBS_METHOD_* API added. Chapter "RAW zero-copy interface" added. Chapter "SNTP client" added. 2.12 0 Chapter "FTP client (Add-on)" updated. * DELE command added for IP_FTPC_ExecCmd() . 2.10 0 120913 Minor updates and corrections. Chapter "UPnP (Add-on)" added. Chapter "VLAN" added. Chapter "Core functions" updated. * IP_NI_ForceCaps() added. * IP_ARP_ConfigAgeout() added. * IP_ARP_ConfigAgeoutNoReply() added. * IP_ARP_ConfigAgeoutSniff() added. * IP_ARP_ConfigAllowGratuitousARP() added. * IP_ARP_ConfigMaxRetries() added. * IP_ARP_ConfigNumEntries() added. * IP_IFaceIsReadyEx() added. * IP_IGMP_Add() added. * IP_IGMP_JoinGroup() added. * IP_IGMP_LeaveGroup() added. Chapter "UDP zero-copy interface" updated. * IP_UDP_GetFPort() added. Chapter "Web server (Add-on)" updated. * Information regarding file uploads added. OO * More detailed description about multiuple connections added. * IP_WEBS_AddFileTypeHook() added. * IP_WEBS_AddVFileHook() added. * IP_WEBS_ConfigSendVFileHeader() added. * IP_WEBS_ConfigSendVFileHookHeader() added. * IP_WEBS_GetParaValuePtr() added. * IP_WEBS_SendHeader() added. Chapter "PPP/PPPoE (Add-on)" updated. * IP_MODEM_Connect() added. * IP_MODEM_Disconnect() added. * IP_MODEM_GetResponse() added. * IP_MODEM_SendString() added. * IP_MODEM_SendStringEx() added. * IP_MODEM_SetAuthInfo() added. * IP_MODEM_SetConnectTimeout() added. * IP_MODEM_SetInitCallback() added. * IP_MODEM_SetInitString() added. * IP_MODEM_SetSwitchToCmdDelay() added. 2.02c 0 120706 OO Minor updates and corrections. 2.02a 0 120514 OO UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP Chapter "AutoIP" added. Chapter "Address Collision Detection" added. (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 5 Software 2.02 Revision 0 Date By Description 120507 Documentation updated for embOS/IP V2 stack. Chapter "API functions" updated. * "IP_GetRawPacketInfo()" added. * "IP_ICMP_Add()" added. OO * "IP_TCP_Add()" added. * "IP_UDP_Add()" added. Chapter "PPP" added. Chapter "NetBIOS" added. 1.60 0 100324 SK Chapter "API functions" updated. * "IP_SetSupportedDuplexModes()" added. Chapter "FTP client" added. Minor updates and corrections. 1.58 0 100204 SK Chapter "SMTP client" updated. Chapter "Configuration" updated. * Section "Required buffers" updated. Minor updates and corrections. 1.56 0 090710 SK Chapter "API functions" updated. * "IP_DNSC_SetMaxTLL()" added. Chapter "Configuring embOS/IP" updated. * Macro "IP_TCP_ACCEPT_CHECKSUM_FFFF" added. 1.54b 0 090603 SK Chapter "Web server (Add-on)" updated. * "IP_WEBS_Process()" updated. * "IP_WEBS_ProcessLast()" added. * "IP_WEBS_OnConnectionLimit()" updated. SK Chapter "API functions" updated. * IP_GetAddrMask() updated. * IP_GetGWMask() updated. * IP_GetIPMask() updated. Chapter "Web server (Add-on)" updated. * Section "Changing the file system type" added. * Section "IP_WEBS_SetFileInfoCallback" updated. 1.54a 1 090520 1.54a 0 090508 SK Chapter "Web server (Add-on)" updated. * IP_WEBS_GetNumParas() added. * IP_WEBS_GetParaValue() added. * IP_WEBS_DecodeAndCopyStr() added. * IP_WEBS_DecodeString() added. * IP_WEBS_SetFileInfoCallback() added. * IP_WEBS_CompareFilenameExt() added. * Section "Dynamic content" added * Section "Common Gateway interface" moved into section "Dynamic content". Chapter "Socket interface" * getpeername() corrected. Chapter "Network interface drivers" updated. 1.54 0 090504 SK Chapter "UDP zero-copy" updated. 1.52 1 090402 SK Chapter "SMTP client" added. SK Chapter "API functions": * IP_SetTxBufferSize() added. * IP_GetIPAddr() updated. * IP_PrintIPAddr() updated. SK Chapter "API functions": * IP_ICMP_SetRxHook() added. * IP_SetRxHook() added. * IP_SOCKET_SetDefaultOptions() added. * IP_SOCKET_SetLimit() added. SK Chapter "Web server (Add-on)": * List of valid values for CGI parameter and values added. Chapter "FTP Server (Add-on)": * Section "FTP server system time" added. * pfGetTimeDate() added. 1.52 1.50 1.42 0 0 0 090223 081210 080821 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 6 Software Revision Date By Description 1.40 0 080731 SK Chapter "API functions": * IP_TCP_SetConnKeepaliveOpt() added. * IP_TCP_SetRetransDelayRange() added. * IP_SendPacket() added. Chapter "Socket interface": * getsockopt() updated. * setsockopt() updated. Chapter "OS integration": * IP_OS_WaitItemTimed() added. 1.30 1 080610 SK Chapter "FTP server (Add-on)" section "Resource usage" added Chapter "Web server (Add-on)" section "Resource usage" added 1.30 0 080423 SK Chapter "FTP server (Add-on)" added. Chapter "Web server (Add-on)" updated. 1.24 3 080320 SK Chapter "Socket interface": * getpeername added. * getsockname added. 1.24 2 080222 SK Chapter "Device Driver": * NXP LPC23xx/24xx driver added. SK Chapter "HTTP server (Add-on)" updated. Chapter "API functions": * IP_UTIL_EncodeBase64() added. * IP_UTIL_DecodeBase64() added. SK Chapter "HTTP server (Add-on)" added: Chapter "API functions": * IP_AllowBackPressure() added. * IP_GetIPAddr() added. * IP_SendPing() added. * IP_SetDefaultTTL() added. SK Chapter "Introduction": * Section "Components of an Ethernet system" added. Chapter "API functions": * IP_IsIFaceReady() added. * IP_NI_ConfigPHYAddr() added. * IP_NI_ConfigPHYMode() added. * IP_NI_ConfigBasePtr () added. Chapter "Socket interface": * All functions: parameter description enhanced. Chapter "Device drivers" renamed to "Network interface drivers". Chapter "Network interface drivers": * Section "ATMEL AT91SAM7X" added. * Section "ATMEL AT91SAM9260"added. * Section "Davicom DM9000"added. * Section "ST STR912"added. SK Chapter "OS Integration": * IP_OS_Sleep() removed. * IP_OS_Wakeup() removed. * IP_OS_WaitItem added. * IP_OS_SignalItem added. Chapter "Running embOS/IP on target hardware" updated. SK Chapter "Socket interface": * gethostbyname() added. * Structure hostent added. Chapter "Core functions": * IP_PrintIPAddr() added. * IP_DNS_SetServer() added. SK Chapter "DHCP": * IP_DHCPC_Activate() updated. Chapter "Debugging": * Section "Testing stability" added. Chapter "Socket interface": * Section "Error codes" added. 1.24 1.24 1.22 1.22 1.22 1.22 1 0 4 3 2 1 080124 080124 071213 071126 071123 071122 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 7 Software 1.22 1.00 Revision 0 2 Date 071114 071017 By Description SK Chapter "Introduction": * "Request for comments" enhanced. Chapter "API functions": * IP_AddLogFilter() added. * IP_AddWarnFilter() added. * IP_GetCurrentLinkSpeed() added. * IP_TCP_Set2MSLDelay() added. * select() added. Various function descriptions enhanced. Chapter "API functions" renamed to "core functions". Socket functions removed from chapter "API functions" Chapter "Socket interface" added. Chapter "DHCP" added. Chapter "UDP zero copy" added. Chapter "TCP zero copy" added. Chapter "Glossary" added. Chapter "Index" updated. SK Chapter "Introduction": * Section "Features" enhanced. * Section "Basic concepts" added. * Section "Task and interrupt usage" added. * Section "Further readings" added. Chapter "Running embOS/IP" enhanced. Chapter "API functions": * IP_Init() added. * IP_Task() added. * IP_RxTask() added. * IP_GetVersion() added. * IP_SetLogFilter() added. * IP_SetWarnFilter() added. * IP_Panic() removed. * Structure sockaddr added. * Structure sockaddr_in added. * Structure in_addr added. Chapter "Device driver". * General information updated. * Section "Writing your own driver" added. Chapter "Debugging" added. Chapter "Performance and resource usage" added. Chapter "OS integration" updated. 1.00 1 071002 SK Product name changed to "embOS/IP": Chapter "API functions": * IP_X_Prepare() renamed to IP_X_Config(). * IP_AddBuffers() added. * IP_ConfTCPSpace() added. 1.00 0 070927 SK Initial version. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 8 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 9 About this document Assumptions This document assumes that you already have a solid knowledge of the following: * * * * The software tools used for building your application (assembler, linker, C compiler) The C programming language The target processor DOS command line If you feel that your knowledge of C is not sufficient, we recommend The C Programming Language by Kernighan and Richie (ISBN 0-13-1103628), which describes the standard in C-programming and, in newer editions, also covers the ANSI C standard. How to use this manual This manual explains all the functions and macros that the product offers. It assumes you have a working knowledge of the C language. Knowledge of assembly programming is not required. Typographic conventions for syntax This manual uses the following typographic conventions: Style Used for Body Body text. Keyword Text that you enter at the command-prompt or that appears on the display (that is system functions, file- or pathnames). Parameter Parameters in API functions. Sample Sample code in program examples. Sample comment Comments in programm examples. Reference Reference to chapters, sections, tables and figures or other documents. GUIElement Buttons, dialog boxes, menu names, menu commands. Emphasis Very important sections. Table 1.1: Typographic conventions UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 10 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG develops and distributes software development tools and ANSI C software components (middleware) for embedded systems in several industries such as telecom, medical technology, consumer electronics, automotive industry and industrial automation. SEGGER's intention is to cut software development time for embedded applications by offering compact flexible and easy to use middleware, allowing developers to concentrate on their application. Our most popular products are emWin, a universal graphic software package for embedded applications, and embOS, a small yet efficient real-time kernel. emWin, written entirely in ANSI C, can easily be used on any CPU and most any display. It is complemented by the available PC tools: Bitmap Converter, Font Converter, Simulator and Viewer. embOS supports most 8/16/32-bit CPUs. Its small memory footprint makes it suitable for single-chip applications. Apart from its main focus on software tools, SEGGER develops and produces programming tools for flash micro controllers, as well as J-Link, a JTAG emulator to assist in development, debugging and production, which has rapidly become the industry standard for debug access to ARM cores. Corporate Office: http://www.segger.com EMBEDDED SOFTWARE (Middleware) emWin Graphics software and GUI emWin is designed to provide an efficient, processor- and display controller-independent graphical user interface (GUI) for any application that operates with a graphical display. embOS Real Time Operating System embOS is an RTOS designed to offer the benefits of a complete multitasking system for hard real time applications with minimal resources. embOS/IP TCP/IP stack embOS/IP a high-performance TCP/IP stack that has been optimized for speed, versatility and a small memory footprint. United States Office: http://www.segger-us.com SEGGER TOOLS Flasher Flash programmer Flash Programming tool primarily for micro controllers. J-Link JTAG emulator for ARM cores USB driven JTAG interface for ARM cores. J-Trace JTAG emulator with trace USB driven JTAG interface for ARM cores with Trace memory. supporting the ARM ETM (Embedded Trace Macrocell). J-Link / J-Trace Related Software Add-on software to be used with SEGGER's industry standard JTAG emulator, this includes flash programming software and flash breakpoints. emFile File system emFile is an embedded file system with FAT12, FAT16 and FAT32 support. Various Device drivers, e.g. for NAND and NOR flashes, SD/MMC and CompactFlash cards, are available. USB-Stack USB device/host stack A USB stack designed to work on any embedded system with a USB controller. Bulk communication and most standard device classes are supported. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 11 Table of Contents 1 Introduction to embOS/IP...............................................................................................17 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.3.1 1.3.2 1.4 1.5 1.5.1 1.6 1.6.1 1.6.2 1.7 What is embOS/IP ................................................................................... 18 Features................................................................................................. 18 Basic concepts ........................................................................................ 19 embOS/IP structure ................................................................................. 19 Encapsulation.......................................................................................... 20 Tasks and interrupt usage......................................................................... 21 Background information ........................................................................... 24 Components of an Ethernet system ............................................................ 24 Further reading ....................................................................................... 27 Request for Comments (RFC) .................................................................... 27 Related books ......................................................................................... 28 Development environment (compiler)......................................................... 29 2 Running embOS/IP on target hardware.........................................................................31 2.1 2.2 2.3 Step 1: Open an embOS start project......................................................... 33 Step 2: Adding embOS/IP to the start project.............................................. 34 Step 3: Build the project and test it ........................................................... 36 3 Example applications .....................................................................................................37 3.1 3.1.1 3.1.2 3.1.3 3.1.4 3.1.5 3.1.6 3.1.7 3.1.8 41 Overview ................................................................................................ 38 embOS/IP DNS client (OS_IP_DNSClient.c) ................................................. 39 embOS/IP non-blocking connect (OS_IP_NonBlockingConnect.c).................... 39 embOS/IP ping (OS_IP_Ping.c).................................................................. 39 embOS/IP shell (OS_IP_Shell.c) ................................................................ 39 embOS/IP simple server (OS_IP_SimpleServer.c) ........................................ 40 embOS/IP speed client (OS_IP_SpeedClient_TCP.c) ..................................... 40 embOS/IP start (OS_IP_Start.c) ................................................................ 41 embOS/IP UDP discover (OS_IP_UDPDiscover.c / OS_IP_UDPDiscoverZeroCopy.c) 4 Core functions................................................................................................................43 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 4.6 API functions .......................................................................................... 44 Configuration functions............................................................................. 47 Management functions ............................................................................. 99 Network interface configuration and handling functions............................... 105 Other IP stack functions ......................................................................... 111 Stack internal functions, variables and data-structures ............................... 140 5 Socket interface ...........................................................................................................141 5.1 5.2 5.3 API functions ........................................................................................ 142 Socket data structures ........................................................................... 169 Error codes ........................................................................................... 173 6 TCP zero-copy interface ..............................................................................................175 6.1 6.1.1 6.1.2 6.2 TCP zero-copy ....................................................................................... 176 Allocating, freeing and sending packet buffers ........................................... 176 Callback function ................................................................................... 176 Sending data with the TCP zero-copy API.................................................. 177 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 12 6.2.1 6.2.2 6.2.3 6.3 6.3.1 6.3.2 6.4 Allocating a packet buffer ........................................................................177 Filling the allocated buffer with data .........................................................177 Sending the packet.................................................................................177 Receiving data with the TCP zero-copy API ................................................178 Writing a callback function.......................................................................178 Registering the callback function ..............................................................178 API functions .........................................................................................179 7 UDP zero-copy interface..............................................................................................185 7.1 7.1.1 7.1.2 7.2 7.2.1 7.2.2 7.2.3 7.3 7.3.1 7.3.2 7.4 UDP zero-copy .......................................................................................186 Allocating, freeing and sending packet buffers............................................186 Callback function....................................................................................186 Sending data with the UDP zero-copy API ..................................................187 Allocating a packet buffer ........................................................................187 Filling the allocated buffer with data .........................................................187 Sending the packet.................................................................................187 Receiving data with the UDP zero-copy API................................................188 Writing a callback function.......................................................................188 Registering the callback function ..............................................................188 API functions .........................................................................................189 8 RAW zero-copy interface .............................................................................................205 8.1 8.1.1 8.1.2 8.2 8.2.1 8.2.2 8.2.3 8.3 8.3.1 8.3.2 8.4 RAW zero-copy ......................................................................................206 Allocating, freeing and sending packet buffers............................................206 Callback function....................................................................................206 Sending data with the RAW zero-copy API .................................................207 Allocating a packet buffer ........................................................................207 Filling the allocated buffer with data .........................................................207 Sending the packet.................................................................................207 Receiving data with the RAW zero-copy API ...............................................209 Writing a callback function.......................................................................209 Registering the callback function ..............................................................209 API functions .........................................................................................210 9 DHCP client .................................................................................................................223 9.1 9.2 DHCP backgrounds .................................................................................224 API functions .........................................................................................225 10 DHCP server (Add-on)...............................................................................................235 10.1 10.2 10.3 10.3.1 10.3.2 10.3.3 DHCP backgrounds .................................................................................236 API functions .........................................................................................237 DHCP server resource usage ....................................................................245 ROM usage on an ARM7 system ...............................................................245 ROM usage on a Cortex-M3 system ..........................................................245 RAM usage ............................................................................................245 11 AutoIP ........................................................................................................................247 11.1 11.2 11.3 11.3.1 11.3.2 11.3.3 embOS/IP AutoIP backgrounds ................................................................248 API functions .........................................................................................249 AutoIP resource usage ............................................................................254 ROM usage on an ARM7 system ...............................................................254 ROM usage on a Cortex-M3 system ..........................................................254 RAM usage ............................................................................................254 12 Address Collision Detection .......................................................................................255 12.1 12.2 12.3 12.4 embOS/IP ACD backgrounds....................................................................256 API functions .........................................................................................257 ACD data structures ...............................................................................260 ACD resource usage ...............................................................................261 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 13 12.4.1 12.4.2 12.4.3 ROM usage on an ARM7 system............................................................... 261 ROM usage on a Cortex-M3 system .......................................................... 261 RAM usage ........................................................................................... 261 13 UPnP (Add-on)...........................................................................................................263 13.1 13.2 13.3 13.4 13.4.1 13.5 13.6 13.6.1 13.6.2 13.6.3 embOS/IP UPnP .................................................................................... 264 Feature list ........................................................................................... 265 Requirements........................................................................................ 266 UPnP backgrounds ................................................................................. 267 Using UPnP to advertise your service in the network................................... 267 API functions ........................................................................................ 275 UPnP resource usage.............................................................................. 277 ROM usage on an ARM7 system............................................................... 277 ROM usage on a Cortex-M3 system .......................................................... 277 RAM usage ........................................................................................... 277 14 VLAN..........................................................................................................................279 14.1 14.2 14.3 14.4 14.5 14.5.1 14.5.2 14.5.3 embOS/IP VLAN .................................................................................... 280 Feature list ........................................................................................... 281 VLAN backgrounds................................................................................. 282 API functions ........................................................................................ 283 VLAN resource usage ............................................................................. 285 ROM usage on an ARM7 system............................................................... 285 ROM usage on a Cortex-M3 system .......................................................... 285 RAM usage ........................................................................................... 285 15 Network interface drivers ...........................................................................................287 15.1 15.1.1 15.1.2 15.1.3 15.2 15.2.1 15.2.2 15.2.3 15.2.4 15.2.5 15.2.6 15.2.7 15.2.8 15.2.9 15.3 15.3.1 General information ............................................................................... 288 MAC address filtering ............................................................................. 288 Checksum computation in hardware ......................................................... 288 Ethernet CRC computation ...................................................................... 288 Available network interface drivers........................................................... 289 ATMEL AT91CAP9 .................................................................................. 290 ATMEL AT91RM9200 .............................................................................. 295 ATMEL AT91SAM7X................................................................................ 299 ATMEL AT91SAM9260 ............................................................................ 303 DAVICOM DM9000/DM9000A .................................................................. 306 FREESCALE ColdFire MCF5329 ................................................................. 309 NXP LPC17xx ........................................................................................ 312 NXP LPC23xx / 24xx .............................................................................. 314 ST STR912 ........................................................................................... 316 Writing your own driver .......................................................................... 318 Device driver functions ........................................................................... 320 16 Configuring embOS/IP ...............................................................................................325 16.1 16.1.1 16.1.2 16.1.3 16.2 16.2.1 16.2.2 Runtime configuration ............................................................................ 326 IP_X_Configure()................................................................................... 326 Driver handling ..................................................................................... 327 Memory and buffer assignment................................................................ 328 Compile-time configuration ..................................................................... 330 Compile-time configuration switches ........................................................ 330 Debug level .......................................................................................... 331 17 Web server (Add-on)..................................................................................................333 17.1 17.2 17.3 17.4 17.4.1 embOS/IP web server ............................................................................ 334 Feature list ........................................................................................... 335 Requirements........................................................................................ 336 HTTP backgrounds ................................................................................. 337 HTTP communication basics .................................................................... 337 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 14 17.4.2 17.5 17.5.1 17.5.2 17.5.3 17.6 17.6.1 17.6.2 17.7 17.7.1 17.7.2 17.8 17.8.1 17.9 17.9.1 17.10 17.10.1 17.11 17.12 17.13 17.13.1 17.13.2 17.13.3 HTTP status codes ..................................................................................338 Using the web server sample ...................................................................339 Using the Windows sample ......................................................................340 Running the web server example on target hardware ..................................340 Changing the file system type ..................................................................341 Dynamic content ....................................................................................342 Common Gateway Interface (CGI) ............................................................342 Virtual files............................................................................................344 Authentication .......................................................................................346 Authentication example...........................................................................347 Configuration of the authentication ...........................................................348 Form handling .......................................................................................349 Simple form processing sample ................................................................350 File upload ............................................................................................353 Simple form upload sample .....................................................................353 Configuration.........................................................................................355 Compile time configuration switches .........................................................355 API functions .........................................................................................357 Web server data structures......................................................................393 Resource usage .....................................................................................403 ROM usage on an ARM7 system ...............................................................403 ROM usage on a Cortex-M3 system ..........................................................403 RAM usage:...........................................................................................403 18 SMTP client (Add-on).................................................................................................405 18.1 18.2 18.3 18.4 18.5 18.5.1 18.6 18.7 18.8 18.8.1 18.8.2 embOS/IP SMTP client ............................................................................406 Feature list............................................................................................407 Requirements ........................................................................................408 SMTP backgrounds .................................................................................409 Configuration.........................................................................................411 Compile time configuration switches .........................................................411 API functions .........................................................................................412 SMTP client data structures .....................................................................414 Resource usage .....................................................................................422 Resource usage on an ARM7 system .........................................................422 Resource usage on a Cortex-M3 system ....................................................422 19 FTP server (Add-on) ..................................................................................................423 19.1 19.2 19.3 19.4 19.4.1 19.4.2 19.4.3 19.4.4 19.5 19.5.1 19.5.2 19.6 19.7 19.7.1 19.7.2 19.8 19.9 19.10 19.10.1 19.10.2 19.10.3 embOS/IP FTP server..............................................................................424 Feature list............................................................................................425 Requirements ........................................................................................426 FTP basics .............................................................................................427 Active mode FTP ....................................................................................428 Passive mode FTP ..................................................................................429 FTP reply codes......................................................................................430 Supported FTP commands .......................................................................431 Using the FTP server sample ....................................................................432 Using the Windows sample ......................................................................432 Running the FTP server example on target hardware...................................432 Access control........................................................................................433 Configuration.........................................................................................439 Compile time configuration switches .........................................................439 FTP server system time...........................................................................440 API functions .........................................................................................442 FTP server data structures.......................................................................445 Resource usage .....................................................................................448 ROM usage on an ARM7 system ...............................................................448 ROM usage on a Cortex-M3 system ..........................................................448 RAM usage:...........................................................................................448 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 15 20 FTP client (Add-on)....................................................................................................449 20.1 20.2 20.3 20.4 20.4.1 20.4.2 20.5 20.5.1 20.6 20.7 20.8 20.8.1 20.8.2 20.8.3 embOS/IP FTP client .............................................................................. 450 Feature list ........................................................................................... 451 Requirements........................................................................................ 452 FTP basics ............................................................................................ 453 Passive mode FTP .................................................................................. 454 Supported FTP client commands .............................................................. 455 Configuration ........................................................................................ 456 Compile time configuration switches......................................................... 456 API functions ........................................................................................ 457 FTP client data structures ....................................................................... 465 Resource usage ..................................................................................... 466 ROM usage on an ARM7 system............................................................... 466 ROM usage on a Cortex-M3 system .......................................................... 466 RAM usage: .......................................................................................... 466 21 TFTP client/server......................................................................................................467 21.1 21.2 21.3 21.4 21.4.1 21.5 21.6 21.6.1 21.6.2 21.6.3 embOS/IP TFTP ..................................................................................... 468 Feature list ........................................................................................... 469 TFTP basics........................................................................................... 470 Using the TFTP samples.......................................................................... 471 Running the TFTP server example on target hardware ................................ 471 API functions ........................................................................................ 472 Resource usage ..................................................................................... 477 ROM usage on an ARM7 system............................................................... 477 ROM usage on a Cortex-M3 system .......................................................... 477 RAM usage: .......................................................................................... 477 22 PPP / PPPoE (Add-on) ..............................................................................................479 22.1 22.2 22.3 22.4 22.5 22.6 22.7 22.8 22.9 22.10 22.10.1 22.10.2 22.10.3 22.11 22.11.1 22.11.2 embOS/IP PPP/PPPoE ............................................................................. 480 Feature list ........................................................................................... 481 Requirements........................................................................................ 482 PPP backgrounds ................................................................................... 483 API functions ........................................................................................ 484 PPPoE functions..................................................................................... 485 PPP functions ........................................................................................ 491 Modem functions ................................................................................... 497 PPP data structures................................................................................ 509 PPPoE resource usage ............................................................................ 515 ROM usage on an ARM7 system............................................................... 515 ROM usage on a Cortex-M3 system .......................................................... 515 RAM usage ........................................................................................... 515 PPP resource usage................................................................................ 516 ROM usage on an ARM7 system............................................................... 516 RAM usage ........................................................................................... 516 23 NetBIOS (Add-on)......................................................................................................517 23.1 23.2 23.3 23.4 23.5 23.6 23.6.1 23.6.2 23.6.3 embOS/IP NetBIOS................................................................................ 518 Feature list ........................................................................................... 519 Requirements........................................................................................ 520 NetBIOS backgrounds ............................................................................ 521 API functions ........................................................................................ 522 Resource usage ..................................................................................... 527 ROM usage on an ARM7 system............................................................... 527 ROM usage on a Cortex-M3 system .......................................................... 527 RAM usage ........................................................................................... 527 24 SNTP client (Add-on) .................................................................................................529 24.1 embOS/IP SNTP client ............................................................................ 530 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 16 24.2 24.3 24.4 24.4.1 24.4.2 24.5 24.6 24.6.1 24.6.2 24.6.3 Feature list............................................................................................531 Requirements ........................................................................................532 SNTP backgrounds .................................................................................533 The NTP timestamp ................................................................................533 The epoch problem (year 2036 problem) ...................................................534 API functions .........................................................................................535 Resource usage .....................................................................................539 ROM usage on an ARM7 system ...............................................................539 ROM usage on a Cortex-M3 system ..........................................................539 RAM usage ............................................................................................539 25 Debugging..................................................................................................................541 25.1 25.2 25.3 25.4 25.5 Message output .....................................................................................542 Testing stability .....................................................................................543 API functions .........................................................................................544 Message types .......................................................................................550 Using a network sniffer to analyse communication problems ........................552 26 OS integration ............................................................................................................553 26.1 26.2 26.2.1 General information................................................................................554 OS layer API functions ............................................................................555 Examples ..............................................................................................555 27 Performance & resource usage .................................................................................557 27.1 27.1.1 27.1.2 27.2 27.2.1 27.2.2 Memory footprint ...................................................................................558 ARM7 system.........................................................................................558 Cortex-M3 system ..................................................................................559 Performance ..........................................................................................560 ARM7 system.........................................................................................560 Cortex-M3 system ..................................................................................561 28 Appendix A - File system abstraction layer................................................................563 28.1 28.2 28.2.1 28.2.2 28.2.3 28.2.4 File system abstraction layer....................................................................564 File system abstraction layer function table................................................565 emFile interface .....................................................................................567 Read-only file system .............................................................................568 Using the read-only file system ................................................................569 Windows file system interface ..................................................................570 29 Glossary.....................................................................................................................571 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 17 Chapter 1 Introduction to embOS/IP This chapter provides an introduction to using embOS/IP. It explains the basic concepts behind embOS/IP. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 18 CHAPTER 1 1.1 Introduction to embOS/IP What is embOS/IP embOS/IP is a CPU-independent TCP/IP stack. embOS/IP is a high-performance library that has been optimized for speed, versatility and small memory footprint. 1.2 Features embOS/IP is written in ANSI C and can be used on virtually any CPU. Some features of embOS/IP: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * Standard socket interface. High performance. Small footprint. No configuration required. Runs "out-of-the-box". Very simple network interface driver structure. Works seamlessly with embOS in multitasking environment. Zero data copy for ultra fast performance. Non-blocking versions of all functions. Connections limited only by memory availability. Delayed ACKs. Handling gratuitous ARP packets Support for VLAN BSD style "keep-alive" option. Support for messages and warnings in debug build. Drivers for most common Ethernet controllers available. Support for driver side (hardware) checksum computation. Royalty-free. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 19 1.3 Basic concepts 1.3.1 embOS/IP structure embOS/IP is organized in different layers, as shown in the following illustration. Application layer DHCP, DNS, FTP, HTTP, POP3, SMTP, TELNET, SSL, ... Transport layer TCP / UDP Network layer IP, ICMP, IGMP, ARP, RARP, ... Link layer Ethernet (IEEE 802.3), ... A short description of each layer's functionality follows below. Application layer The application layer is the interface between embOS/IP and the user application. It uses the embOS/IP API to transmit data over an TCP/IP network. The embOS/IP API provides functions in BSD (Berkeley Software Distribution) socket style, such as connect(), bind(), listen(), etc. Transport layer The transport layer provides end-to-end communication services for applications. The two relevant protocols of the Transport layer protocol are the Transmission Control Protocol (TCP) and the User Datagram Protocol (UDP). TCP is a reliable connectionoriented transport service. It provides end-to-end reliability, resequencing, and flow control. UDP is a connectionless transport service. Internet layer All protocols of the transport layer use the Internet Protocol (IP) to carry data from source host to destination host. IP is a connectionless service, providing no end-toend delivery guarantees. IP datagrams may arrive at the destination host damaged, duplicated, out of order, or not at all. The transport layer is responsible for reliable delivery of the datagrams when it is required. The IP protocol includes provision for addressing, type-of-service specification, fragmentation and reassembly, and security information. Link layer The link layer provides the implementation of the communication protocol used to interface to the directly-connected network. A variety of communication protocols have been developed and standardized. The most commonly used protocol is Ethernet (IEEE 802.3). In this version of embOS/IP only Ethernet is supported. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 20 CHAPTER 1 1.3.2 Introduction to embOS/IP Encapsulation The four layers structure is defined in [RFC 1122]. The data flow starts at the application layer and goes over the transport layer, the network layer, and the link layer. Every protocol adds an protocol-specific header and encapsulates the data and header from the layer above as data. On the receiving side, the data will be extracted in the complementary direction. The opposed protocols do not know which protocol on the above and below layers are used. The following illustration shows the encapsulation of data within an UDP datagram within an IP packet. UDP header IP header Frame header Data Application layer UDP data Transport layer Network layer IP data Frame data UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP Frame footer Link layer (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 21 1.4 Tasks and interrupt usage embOS/IP can be used in an application in three different ways. * * * One task dedicated to the stack (IP_Task) Two tasks dedicated to the stack (IP_Task, IP_RxTask) Zero tasks dedicated to the stack (Superloop) The default task structure is one task dedicated to the stack. The priority of the management tasks IP_Task (and IP_RxTask if available) should be higher then the priority of an application task which uses the stack. One task dedicated to the stack To use one task dedicated to the stack is the simplest way to use the TCP/IP stack. It is called IP_Task and handles housekeeping operations, resending and handling of incoming packets. The "Read packet" operation is performed from within the ISR. Because the "Read packet" operation is called directly from the ISR, no additional task is required. The length of the interrupt latency will be extended for the time period which is required to process the "Read packet" operation. Refer to IP_Task() on page 102 for more information and an example about how to include the IP_Task into your embOS project. Interrupt (ISR) embOS/IP Rx Task Routine / Action Application tasks IP stack IP_OnRx() IP stack / Driver App. task 1 ... App. t ask n IP_Task IP_Exec() UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP Read packet (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 22 CHAPTER 1 Introduction to embOS/IP Two tasks dedicated to the stack Two tasks are dedicated to the stack. The first task is called the IP_Task and handles housekeeping operations, resends, and handling of incoming packets. The second is called IP_RxTask and handles the "Read packet" operation. IP_RxTask is waked up from the interrupt service routine, if new packets are available. The interrupt latency is not extended, because the "Read packet" operation has been moved from the interrupt service routine to IP_RxTask. Refer to IP_Task() on page 102 and IP_RxTask() on page 103 for more information. IP_RxTask has to have a higher priority as IP_Task as it is treated as interrupt in task form and might not be interrupted by IP_Task or any other IP task. Interrupt (ISR) embOS/IP Rx Task Routine / Action Application tasks IP stack IP_OnRx() IP stack / Driver App. task 1 ... UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP App. t ask n IP_Task IP_RxTask IP_Exec() Read packet (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 23 Zero tasks dedicated to the stack (Superloop) embOS/IP can also be used without any additional task for the stack, if an application task calls IP_Exec() periodically. The "Read packet" operation is performed from within the ISR. Because the "Read packet" operation is called directly from the ISR, no additional task is required. The length of the interrupt latency will be extended for the time period which is required to process the "Read packet" operation. Interrupt (ISR) embOS/IP Rx Task Routine / Action Application tasks IP stack IP_OnRx() IP stack / Driver App. task 1 ... App. t ask n IP_Exec() Read packet Task priorities Task priorities are independent from other task priorities. However as soon as a task calls an IP API it has to obey the following priority rules: 1. 2. 3. The IP_RxTask (if used at all) has to have the highest priority of all tasks that make use of the IP API and has to have a higher priority than the IP_Task . The IP_Task has to have a higher task priority than any other task that makes use of the IP API. It has to have a lower priority than the IP_RxTask (if used at all). All tasks that make use of the IP API have to have a task priority below the IP_Task . Tasks that do not use the IP API do not have to obey these rules and their task priorities can be freely chosen. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 24 CHAPTER 1 1.5 Introduction to embOS/IP Background information 1.5.1 Components of an Ethernet system Main parts of an Ethernet system are the Media Access Controller (MAC) and the Physical device (PHY). The MAC handles generating and parsing physical frames and the PHY handles how this data is actually moved to or from the wire. MCUs with integrated MAC Some modern MCUs (for example, the ATMEL SAM7X or the ST STR912) include the MAC and use the internal RAM to store the Ethernet data. The following block diagram illustrates such a configuration. PHY MAC Connector CPU RAM External Ethernet controllers with MAC and PHY Chips without integrated MAC can use fully integrated single chip Ethernet MAC controller with integrated PHY and a general processor interface. The following schematic illustrates such a configuration. MAC PHY Connector CPU RAM UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 25 1.5.1.1 MII / RMII: Interface between MAC and PHY The MAC communicates with the PHY via the Media Independent Interface (MII) or the Reduced Media Independent Interface (RMII). The MII is defined in IEEE 802.3u. The RMII is a subset of the MII and is defined in the RMI specification. The MII/RMII can handle control over the PHY which allows for selection of such transmission criteria as line speed, duplex mode, etc. In theory, up to 32 PHYs can be connected to a single MAC. In praxis, this is never done; only one PHY is connected. In order to allow multiple PHYs to be connected to a single MAC, individual 5-bit addresses have to be assigned to the different PHYs. If only one PHY is connected, the embOS/IP driver automatically finds the address of it. The standard defines 32 16-bit PHY registers. The first 6 are defined by the standard. Register BMCR BSR PHYSID1 PHYSID2 ANAR LPAR Description Basic Mode Control Register Basic Mode Status Register PHYS ID 1 PHYS ID 2 Auto-Negotiation Advertisement Register Link Partner Ability register Table 1.1: Standardized registers of the MAC/PHY interface The drivers automatically recognize any PHY connected, no manual configuration of PHY address is required. The MII and RMII interface are capable of both 10Mb/s and 100Mb/s data rates as described in the IEEE 802.3u standard. TX_CLK TX_EN TXD 0-1 TXD 2-3 PHYCLK CRS COL MAC MDIO PHY MDC RX_CLK RXD 0-1 RXD 2-3 RX_DV RX_ER The intent of the RMII is to provide a reduced pin count alternative to the IEEE 802.3u MII. It uses 2 bits for transmit (TXD0 and TXD1) and two bits for receive (RXD0 and RXD1). There is a Transmit Enable (TX_EN), a Receive Error (RX_ER), a Carrier Sense (CRS), and a 50 MHz Reference Clock (TX_CLK) for 100Mb/s data rate. The pins used by the MII and RMII interfaces are described in the following table. Signal TX_CLK TX_EN TXD[0:1] TXD[2:3] PHYCLK MII Transmit Clock (25 MHz) Transmit Enable 4-bit Transmit Data PHY Clock Output RMII Reference Clock (50 MHz) Transmit Enable 2-bit Transmit Data N/A PHY Clock Output Table 1.2: MII / RMII comparison UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 26 CHAPTER 1 Signal CRS COL MDIO MDC RX_CLK RXD[0:1] RXD[2:3] RX_DV RX_ER MII RMII Carrier Sense Collision Detect Management data I/O Data Transfer Timing Reference Clock Receive Clock 4-bit Receive Data Data Valid Receive Error Introduction to embOS/IP N/A N/A Management data I/O Data Transfer Timing Reference Clock N/A 2-bit Receive Data N/A Carrier Sense/Data Valid Receive Error Table 1.2: MII / RMII comparison UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 27 1.6 Further reading This guide explains the usage of the embOS/IP protocol stack. It describes all functions which are required to build a network application. For a deeper understanding about how the protocols of the internet protocol suite works use the following references. The following Request for Comments (RFC) define the relevant protocols of the internet protocol suite and have been used to build the protocol stack. They contain all required technical specifications. The listed books are simpler to read as the RFCs and give a general survey about the interconnection of the different protocols. 1.6.1 Request for Comments (RFC) RFC# [RFC 768] [RFC 791] [RFC 792] [RFC 793] [RFC 821] [RFC 826] [RFC 951] [RFC 959] [RFC 1034] [RFC 1035] [RFC 1042] [RFC 1122] [RFC 1123] [RFC 1661] [RFC 1939] [RFC 2131] [RFC 2616] Description UDP - User Datagram Protocol Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc768.txt IP - Internet Protocol Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc791.txt ICMP - Internet Control Message Protocol Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc792.txt TCP - Transmission Control Protocol Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc793.txt SMTP - Simple Mail Transfer Protocol Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc826.txt ARP - Ethernet Address Resolution Protocol Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc826.txt BOOTP - Bootstrap Protocol Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc951.txt FTP - File Transfer Protocol Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc959.txt DNS - Domain names - concepts and facilities Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc1034.txt DNS - Domain names - implementation and specification Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc1035.txt IE-EEE - Transmission of IP datagrams over IEEE 802 networks Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc1042.txt Requirements for Internet Hosts - Communication Layers Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc1122.txt Requirements for Internet Hosts - Application and Support Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc1123.txt PPP - Point-to-Point Protocol Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc1661.txt POP3 - Post Office Protocol - Version 3 Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc1939.txt DHCP - Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc2131.txt HTTP - Hypertext Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.1 Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc2616.txt UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 28 CHAPTER 1 1.6.2 * * * * * Introduction to embOS/IP Related books [Comer] - Computer Networks and Internets, Douglas E Comer and Ralph E. Droms - ISBN: 978-0131433519 [Tannenbaum] - Computer Networks, Andrew S. Tannenbaum ISBN: 978-0130661029 [StevensV1] - TCP/IP Illustrated, Volume 1, W. Richard Stevens ISBN: 978-0201633467. [StevensV2] - TCP/IP Illustrated, Volume 2, W. Richard Stevens and Gary R. Wright - ISBN: 978-0201633542. [StevensV3] - TCP/IP Illustrated, Volume 3, W. Richard Stevens ISBN: 978-0201634952. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 29 1.7 Development environment (compiler) The CPU used is of no importance; only an ANSI-compliant C compiler complying with at least one of the following international standard is required: * * * ISO/IEC/ANSI 9899:1990 (C90) with support for C++ style comments (//) ISO/IEC 9899:1999 (C99) ISO/IEC 14882:1998 (C++) If your compiler has some limitations, let us know and we will inform you if these will be a problem when compiling the software. Any compiler for 16/32/64-bit CPUs or DSPs that we know of can be used; most 8-bit compilers can be used as well. A C++ compiler is not required, but can be used. The application program can therefore also be programmed in C++ if desired. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 30 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP CHAPTER 1 Introduction to embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 31 Chapter 2 Running embOS/IP on target hardware This chapter explains how to integrate and run embOS/IP on your target hardware. It explains this process step-by-step. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 32 CHAPTER 2 Running embOS/IP on target hardware Integrating embOS/IP The embOS/IP default configuration is preconfigured with valid values, which matches the requirements of the most applications. embOS/IP is designed to be used with embOS, SEGGER's real-time operating system. We recommend to start with an embOS sample project and include embOS/IP into this project. We assume that you are familiar with the tools you have selected for your project (compiler, project manager, linker, etc.). You should therefore be able to add files, add directories to the include search path, and so on. In this document the IAR Embedded Workbench (R) IDE is used for all examples and screenshots, but every other ANSI C toolchain can also be used. It is also possible to use make files; in this case, when we say "add to the project", this translates into "add to the make file". Procedure to follow Integration of embOS/IP is a relatively simple process, which consists of the following steps: * * * Step 1: Open an embOS project and compile it. Step 2: Add embOS/IP to the start project Step 3: Compile the project UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 33 2.1 Step 1: Open an embOS start project We recommend that you use one of the supplied embOS start projects for your target system. Compile the project and run it on your target hardware. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 34 CHAPTER 2 2.2 Running embOS/IP on target hardware Step 2: Adding embOS/IP to the start project Add all source files in the following directory to your project: * * * Config IP UTIL (optional) The Config folder includes all configuration files of embOS/IP. The configuration files are preconfigured with valid values, which match the requirements of most applications. Add the hardware configuration IP_Config_.c supplied with the driver shipment. If your hardware is currently not supported, use the example configuration file and the driver template to write your own driver. The example configuration file and the driver template is located in the Sample\Driver\Template folder. The Util folder is an optional component of the embOS/IP shipment. It contains optimized MCU and/or compiler specific files, for example a special memcopy function. Replace BSP.c and BSP.h of your embOS start project Replace the BSP.c source file and the BSP.h header file used in your embOS start project with the one which is supplied with the embOS/IP shipment. Some drivers require a special functions which initializes the network interface of the driver. This function is called BSP_ETH_Init(). It is used to enable the ports which are connected to the network hardware. All network interface driver packages include the BSP.c and BSP.h files irrespective if the BSP_ETH_Init() function is implemented. Configuring the include path The include path is the path in which the compiler looks for include files. In cases where the included files (typically header files, .h) do not reside in the same directory as the C file to compile, an include path needs to be set. In order to build the project with all added files, you will need to add the following directories to your include path: * * * Config Inc IP UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 35 Select the start application For quick and easy testing of your embOS/IP integration, start with the code found in the folder Application. Add one of the applications to your project (for example OS_IP_SimpleServer.c). UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 36 2.3 CHAPTER 2 Running embOS/IP on target hardware Step 3: Build the project and test it Build the project. It should compile without errors and warnings. If you encounter any problem during the build process, check your include path and your project configuration settings. To test the project, download the output into your target and start the application. By default, ICMP is activated. This means that you could ping your target. Open the command line interface of your operating system and enter ping , to check if the stack runs on your target. The target should answer all pings without any error. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 37 Chapter 3 Example applications In this chapter, you will find a description of each embOS/IP example application. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 38 3.1 CHAPTER 3 Example applications Overview Various example applications for embOS/IP are supplied. These can be used for testing the correct installation and proper function of the device running embOS/IP. The following start application files are provided: File Description OS_IP_DNSClient.c Demonstrates the use of the integrated DNS client. OS_IP_NonBlockingConnect.c Demonstrates how to connect to a server using non-blocking sockets. OS_IP_Ping.c Demonstrates how to send ICMP echo requests and how to process ICMP replies in application. OS_IP_Shell.c Demonstrates using the IP-shell to diagnose the IP stack. OS_IP_SimpleServer.c Demonstrates setup of a simple server which simply sends back the target system tick for every character received. OS_IP_SpeedClient_TCP.c Demonstrates the TCP send and receive performance of the device running embOS/IP. Refer to embOS/IP speed client (OS_IP_SpeedClient_TCP.c) on page 40 for detailed information. OS_IP_Start.c Demonstrates use of the IP stack without any server or client program. To ping the target, use the command line: ping where represents the IP address of the target, which depends on the configuration and is usually 192.168.5.1 if the DHCP client is not enabled. OS_IP_UDPDiscover.c Demonstrates setup of a simple UDP application which replies to UDP broadcasts. The application sends an answer for every received discover packet. The related host application sends discover packets as UDP broadcasts and waits for the feedback of the targets which are available in the subnet. OS_IP_UDPDiscoverZeroCopy.c Demonstrates setup of a simple UDP application which replies to UDP broadcasts. The application uses the the embOS/IP zero-copy interface. It sends an answer for every received discover packet. The related host application sends discover packets as UDP broadcasts and waits for the feedback of the targets which are available in the subnet. Table 3.1: embOS/IP example applications The example applications for the target-side are supplied in source code in the Application directory. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 39 3.1.1 embOS/IP DNS client (OS_IP_DNSClient.c) The embOS/IP DNS client resolves a hostname (for example, segger.com) to an IP address and outputs the resolved address via terminal I/O. 3.1.2 embOS/IP non-blocking connect (OS_IP_NonBlockingConnect.c) The embOS/IP non-blocking connect sample demonstrates how to connect to a server using non-blocking sockets. The target tries to connect to TCP server with an non-blocking socket. The sample can be used with any TCP server independent of the application which is listening on the port. The client only opens a TCP connection to the server and closes it without any further communication. The terminal I/O output in your debugger should be similar to the following out: Connecting using non-blocking socket... Successfully connected after 2ms! 1 of 1 tries were successful. Connecting using non-blocking socket... Successfully connected after 1ms! 2 of 2 tries were successful. 3.1.3 embOS/IP ping (OS_IP_Ping.c) The embOS/IP ping sample demonstrates how to send ICMP echo requests and how to process received ICMP packets in your application. A callback function is implemented which outputs a message if an ICMP echo reply or an ICMP echo request has been received. To test the embOS/IP ICMP implementation, you have to perform the following steps: 1. 2. Customize the Local defines, configurable section of OS_IP_Ping.c. Change the macro HOST_TO_PING accordant to your configuration. For example, if the Windows host PC which you want to ping use the IP address 192.168.5.15, change the HOST_TO_PING macro to 0xC0A8050F. Open the command line interface and enter: ping [IP_ADDRESS _OF_YOUR_TARGET_RUNNING_EMBOSIP] The terminal I/O output in your debugger should be similar to the following out: ICMP ICMP ICMP ICMP ICMP ICMP ICMP ICMP ICMP ICMP 3.1.4 echo echo echo echo echo echo echo echo echo echo reply received! request received! reply received! reply received! reply received! reply received! request received! reply received! reply received! reply received! embOS/IP shell (OS_IP_Shell.c) The embOS/IP shell server is a task which opens TCP-port 23 (telnet) and waits for a connection. The actual shell server is part of the stack, which keep the application program nice and small. The shell server task can be added to any application and should be used to retrieve status information while the target is running. To connect UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 40 CHAPTER 3 Example applications to the target, use the command line: telnet where represents the IP address of the target, which depends on the configuration and is usually 192.168.5.230 if the DHCP client is not enabled. 3.1.5 embOS/IP simple server (OS_IP_SimpleServer.c) Demonstrates setup of a simple server which simply sends back the target system tick for every character received. It opens TCP-port 23 (telnet) and waits for a connection. To connect to the target, use the command line: telnet where represents the IP address of the target, which depends on the configuration and is usually 192.168.5.230 if the DHCP client is not enabled. 3.1.6 embOS/IP speed client (OS_IP_SpeedClient_TCP.c) The embOS/IP speed client is a small application to detect the TCP send and receive performance of embOS/IP on your hardware. 3.1.6.1 Running the embOS/IP speed client To test the embOS/IP performance, you have to perform the following steps: 1. 2. 3. 4. Start the Windows speed test server. The example application for the host-side is supplied as executable and in source code in the Windows\SpeedTestServer\ directory. To run the speed test server, simply start the executable, for example by double-clicking it or open the supplied Visual C project and compile and start the application. Add OS_IP_SpeedClient.c to your project. Customize the Local defines, configurable section of OS_IP_SpeedClient.c. Change the macro SERVER_IP_ADDR accordant to your configuration. For example, if the Windows host PC running the speed test server uses the IP address 192.168.5.15, change the SERVER_IP_ADDR macro to 0xC0A8050F. If you have changed the port which the Windows host application uses to listen, change the macro SERVER_PORT accordingly. Build and download the speed client into your target. The target connects to the UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 41 server and starts the transmission. 3.1.7 embOS/IP start (OS_IP_Start.c) Demonstrates use of the IP stack without any server or client program. To ping the target, use the command line: ping where represents the IP address of the target, which depends on the configuration and is usually 192.168.5.230 if the DHCP client is not enabled. 3.1.8 embOS/IP UDP discover (OS_IP_UDPDiscover.c / OS_IP_UDPDiscoverZeroCopy.c) To test the embOS/IP UDP discover example, you have to perform the following steps: 1. 2. 3. 4. Start the Windows UDP discover example application. The example application for the host-side is supplied as executable and in source code in the Windows\UDPDiscover\ directory. To run the UDP discover example, simply start the executable, for example by double-clicking it or open the supplied Visual C project and compile and start the application. Add OS_IP_UDPDiscover.c to your project. Customize the Local defines, configurable section of OS_IP_UDPDiscover.c. By default, the example uses port 50020. If you have changed the port that the Windows host application uses, change the macro PORT accordingly. Build and download the UDP discover example into your target. The target sends an answer for every received discover packet. The related host application sends discover packets as UDP broadcasts and waits for the feedback of the targets which are available in the subnet. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 42 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP CHAPTER 3 Example applications (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 43 Chapter 4 Core functions In this chapter, you will find a description of each embOS/IP core function. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 44 4.1 CHAPTER 4 Core functions API functions The table below lists the available API functions within their respective categories. Function Description Configuration functions IP_AddBuffers() Adds buffers to the TCP/IP stack. Adds an Ethernet interface to the IP_AddEtherInterface() stack. IP_AddLoopbackInterface() Adds an Ethernet loopback interface. IP_AllowBackpressure() Activates back pressure. IP_AssignMemory() Assigns memory. IP_ARP_ConfigAgeout() Configures the ARP cache timeout. Configures the ARP cache timeout for IP_ARP_ConfigAgeoutNoReply() request sent without a reply yet. Configures the ARP cache timeout for IP_ARP_ConfigAgeoutSniff() entries sniffed from incoming packets. Configures allow/disallow of using IP_ARP_ConfigAllowGratuitousARP() information from gratuitous ARP packets. Configure max. packets pending for IP_ARP_ConfigMaxPending() reply to an ARP entry. IP_ARP_ConfigMaxRetries() Configures max. ARP request resends. Configures number of ARP cache IP_ARP_ConfigNumEntries() entries. Configures the send and receive IP_ConfigTCPSpace() space. IP_ConfigOffCached2Uncached() Configures cached to uncached offset. IP_DisableIPRxChecksum() Disables IP checksum verification. Retrieves first DNS server from first IP_DNS_GetServer() interface. Retrieves a DNS server from an interIP_DNS_GetServerEx() face. IP_DNS_SetMaxTTL() Sets the maximum TTL of a DNS entry. IP_DNS_SetServer() Sets the DNS server. IP_DNS_SetServerEx() Sets a DNS server for an interface. IP_EnableIPRxChecksum() Enables ICMP checksum verification. IP_GetPrimaryIFace() Retrieves the stacks primary interface. IP_ICMP_Add() Adds ICMP to the stack. IP_ICMP_DisableRxChecksum() Disables ICMP checksum verification. IP_ICMP_EnableRxChecksum() Enables ICMP checksum verification. IP_IGMP_Add() Adds IGMP to the stack. IP_IGMP_JoinGroup() Joins an IGMP group. IP_IGMP_LeaveGroup() Leaves an IGMP group. Select polled mode for the network IP_NI_ConfigPoll() interface. Configures the Tx buffer size used by IP_NI_SetTxBufferSize() the network interface driver. IP_RAW_Add() Adds RAW socket support to the stack. Sets the address mask of the first IP_SetAddrMask() interface interface. Sets the address mask of the selected IP_SetAddrMaskEx() interface. Table 4.1: embOS/IP API function overview UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 45 Function Description Sets the gateway address of the selected interface. Sets the hardware address of the first IP_SetHWAddr() interface. Sets the hardware address of the IP_SetHWAddrEx() selected interface. Sets the maximum transmission unit IP_SetMTU() of an interface. IP_SetPrimaryIFace() Sets primary interface of the stack. IP_SetSupportedDuplexModes() Sets the supported duplex modes. IP_SetTTL() Sets the TTL of an IP packet. Configure the select() timeout multiIP_SOCKET_ConfigSelectMultiplicator() plicator. Sets the socket options which should IP_SOCKET_SetDefaultOptions() be enabled by default. Sets the maximum number of availIP_SOCKET_SetLimit() able sockets. IP_TCP_Add() Adds TCP to the stack. IP_TCP_DisableRxChecksum() Disables TCP checksum verification. IP_TCP_EnableRxChecksum() Enables TCP checksum verification. IP_TCP_Set2MSLDelay() Sets the maximum segment lifetime. IP_TCP_SetConnKeepaliveOpt() Sets the keepalive options. IP_TCP_SetRetransDelayRange() Sets retransmission delay range. IP_UDP_Add() Adds UDP to the stack. IP_UDP_DisableRxChecksum() Disables UDP checksum verification. IP_UDP_EnableRxChecksum() Enables UDP checksum verification. Management functions IP_DeInit() Deinitialization function of the stack. IP_Init() Initialization function of the stack. IP_Task() Main task for starting the stack. Reads all available packets and sleeps IP_RxTask() until a new packet is received. Checks if any packet has been IP_Exec() received and handles timers. Network interface configuration and handling functions IP_NI_ConfigPHYAddr() Configures the PHY address. IP_NI_ConfigPHYMode() Configures the PHY mode. Select polled mode for the network IP_NI_ConfigPoll() interface. Allows forcing of hardware capabiliIP_NI_ForceCaps() ties. Configures the Tx buffer size used by IP_NI_SetTxBufferSize() the network interface driver. Other IP stack functions Adds a hook that will be executed right IP_AddAfterInitHook() after IP_Init(). Adds a hook that will be executed if an IP_AddStateChangeHook() interface state changes from outside. IP_Alloc() Allocate memory from stack. IP_Connect() Calls a previously set callback. IP_Disconnect() Calls a previously set callback. IP_Err2Str() Converts error value to string. IP_SetGWAddr() Table 4.1: embOS/IP API function overview (Continued) UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 46 CHAPTER 4 Core functions Function IP_Free() IP_GetAddrMask() IP_GetCurrentLinkSpeed() IP_GetCurrentLinkSpeedEx() IP_GetGWAddr() IP_GetHWAddr() IP_GetIPAddr() IP_GetIPPacketInfo() IP_GetRawPacketInfo() IP_GetVersion() IP_ICMP_SetRxHook() IP_IFaceIsReady() IP_IFaceIsReadyEx() IP_IsExpired() IP_PrintIPAddr() IP_ResolveHost() IP_SendPacket() IP_SendPing() IP_SendPingEx() IP_SetIFaceConnectHook() IP_SetIFaceDisconnectHook() IP_SetRxHook() Description Free previously allocated memory. Returns the IP address and the subnet mask of the device. Returns the current link speed. Returns the current link speed of the selected interface. Returns the gateway address of the device. Returns the hardware address (MAC) of the device. Returns the IP address of the device. Returns the start address of the data part of an IP packet. Returns the start address of the raw data part of an IP packet. Returns the version number of embOS/IP. Sets a hook function which will be called if target receives a ping packet. Checks if the interface is ready. Checks if the specified interface is ready. Checks if a timestamp has expired. Convert an 4 byte IP address to a dots-and-number string. Resolves a host name via DNS server. Sends a user defined packet on the interface. Sends an ICMP Echo Request. Sends an ICMP Echo Request. Sets a connect callback. Sets a disconnect callback. Sets a hook function that handles all received packets. Table 4.1: embOS/IP API function overview (Continued) UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 47 4.2 Configuration functions UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 48 CHAPTER 4 4.2.1 Core functions IP_AddBuffers() Description Adds buffers to the TCP/IP stack. This is a configuration function, typically called from IP_X_Config(). It needs to be called 2 times, one per buffer size. Prototype void IP_AddBuffers ( int NumBuffers, int BytesPerBuffer ); Parameter Parameter NumBuffers BytesPerBuffer Description [IN] The number of buffers. [IN] Size of buffers in bytes. Table 4.2: IP_AddBuffers() parameter list Additional information embOS/IP requires small and large buffers. We recommend to define the size of the big buffers to 1536 to allow a full Ethernet packet to fit. The small buffers are used to store packets which encapsulates no or few application data like protocol management packets (TCP SYNs, TCP ACKs, etc.). We recommend to define the size of the small buffers to 256 bytes. Example IP_AddBuffers(20, 256); IP_AddBuffers(12, 1536); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP // 20 small buffers, each 256 bytes. // 12 big buffers, each 1536 bytes. (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 49 4.2.2 IP_AddEtherInterface() Description Adds an Ethernet interface. Prototype int IP_AddEtherInterface( const IP_HW_DRIVER * pDriver ); Parameter Parameter pDriver Description [IN] A pointer to a network interface driver structure. Table 4.3: IP_AddEtherInterface() parameter list Additional information Refer to Available network interface drivers on page 289 for a list of available network interface drivers. Return value Zero-based interface index of the newly created interface. Example IP_AddEtherInterface(&IP_Driver_SAM7X); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP // Add Ethernet driver for your hardware (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 50 CHAPTER 4 4.2.3 Core functions IP_AddLoopbackInterface() Description Adds a loopback Ethernet interface. Prototype int IP_AddLoopbackInterface( void ); Return value Zero-based interface index of the newly created interface. Additional information The loopback interface will be added with the pre-configured static IP addr. of 127.0.0.1/8 . Example IP_AddLoopbackInterface(); // Add an Ethernet loopback interface. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 51 4.2.4 IP_AllowBackpressure() Description Allows back pressure if the driver supports this feature. Prototype void IP_AllowBackpressure ( int v ); Parameter Parameter v Description [IN] Zero to disable, 1 to enable back pressure. Table 4.4: IP_AllowBackPressure() parameter list Additional information Back pressure is a window-based flow control mechanism for the half-duplex mode. It is a sort of feedback-based congestion control mechanism. The intent of this mechanism is to prevent loss by providing back pressure to the sending NIC on ports that are going too fast to avoid loss. Back pressure is enabled by default. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 52 CHAPTER 4 4.2.5 Core functions IP_AssignMemory() Description Assigns memory to the TCP/IP stack. Prototype void IP_AssignMemory ( U32 * pMem, U32 NumBytes ); Parameter Parameter pMem NumBytes Description [IN] A pointer to the start of the memory region which should be assigned. [IN] Number of bytes which should be assigned. Table 4.5: IP_AssignMemory() parameter list Additional information IP_AssignMemory() should be the first function which is called in IP_X_Config(). The amount of RAM required depends on the configuration and the respective application purpose. The assigned memory pool is required for the socket buffers, memory buffers, etc. Example #define ALLOC_SIZE 0x8000 U32 _aPool[ALLOC_SIZE / 4]; // Size of memory dedicated to the stack in bytes // Memory area used by the stack. IP_AssignMemory(_aPool, sizeof(_aPool)); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 53 4.2.6 IP_ARP_ConfigAgeout() Description Configures the timeout for cached ARP entries. Prototype void IP_ARP_ConfigAgeout ( U32 Ageout ); Parameter Parameter Ageout Description [IN] Timeout in ms after which an entry is deleted from the ARP cache. Default: 120s. Table 4.6: IP_ARP_ConfigAgeout() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 54 CHAPTER 4 4.2.7 Core functions IP_ARP_ConfigAgeoutNoReply() Description Configures the timeout for an ARP entry that has been added due to sending an ARP request to the network that has not been answered yet. Prototype void IP_ARP_ConfigAgeoutNoReply ( U32 Ageout ); Parameter Parameter Ageout Description [IN] Timeout in ms after which an entry is deleted in case we are still waiting for an ARP response. Default: 3s. Table 4.7: IP_ARP_ConfigAgeoutNoReply() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 55 4.2.8 IP_ARP_ConfigAgeoutSniff() Description Configures the timeout for cached ARP entries that have been cached from incoming packets instead from sending an ARP request. Prototype void IP_ARP_ConfigAgeoutSniff ( U32 Ageout ); Parameter Parameter Ageout Description [IN] Timeout in ms after which an entry is deleted from the ARP cache. Table 4.8: IP_ARP_ConfigAgeoutSniff() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 56 CHAPTER 4 4.2.9 Core functions IP_ARP_ConfigAllowGratuitousARP() Description Configures if gratuitous ARP packets from other network members are allowed to update the ARP cache. Prototype void IP_ARP_AllowGratuitousARP ( U8 OnOff ); Parameter Parameter OnOff Description [IN] 0: Off; 1: On. Default: On. Table 4.9: IP_ConfigAllowGratuitousARP() parameter list Additional information Gratuitous ARP packets allow the network to update itself by sending out informations about changes regarding IP and hardware ID assignments. As this behaviour helps the network to become more stable and helps to manage itself it is on by default. In case you consider gratuitous ARP packets as a security IP_ARP_ConfigAllowGratuitousARP() can be used to disallow this behaviour. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP risk (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 57 4.2.10 IP_ARP_ConfigMaxPending() Description Configures the maximum number packets that can be queued waiting for an ARP reply. Prototype void IP_ARP_ConfigMaxPending ( unsigned NumPackets ); Parameter Parameter NumPackets Description [IN] Maximum number of packets that can be pending for one ARP entry. Default: 3. Table 4.10: IP_ARP_ConfigMaxPending() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 58 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.11 IP_ARP_ConfigMaxRetries() Description Configures how often an ARP request is resent before considering the request failed. Prototype void IP_ARP_ConfigConfigMaxRetries ( unsigned Retries ); Parameter Parameter Retries Description [IN] Number of retries for sending an ARP request. Table 4.11: IP_ARP_ConfigMaxRetries() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 59 4.2.12 IP_ARP_ConfigNumEntries() Description Configures the maximum number of possible entries in the ARP cache. Prototype int IP_ARP_ConfigNumEntries ( unsigned NumEntries ); Parameter Parameter NumEntries Description [IN] Number of max. entries in ARP cache list. Table 4.12: IP_ARP_ConfigNumEntries() parameter list Retrurn value 0: O.K., the stack will try to allocate the requested number of entries. -1: Error, called after IP_Init(). Additional information IP_ARP_ConfigNumEntries() has to be called before IP_Init(). UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 60 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.13 IP_ConfigTCPSpace() Description Configures the size of the TCP send and receive window size. Prototype void IP_ConfigTCPSpace ( unsigned SendSpace, unsigned RecvSpace ); Parameter Parameter SendSpace RecvSpace Description [IN] Size of the send window. [IN] Size of the receive window. Table 4.13: IP_ConfTCPSpace() parameter list Additional information The receive window size is the amount of unacknowledged data a sender can send to the receiver on a particular TCP connection before it gets an acknowledgment. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 61 4.2.14 IP_ConfigOffCached2Uncached() Description Configures the offset from a cached memory area to its uncached equivalent for uncached access. Prototype void IP_ConfigOffCached2Uncached ( I32 Off ); Parameter Parameter Off Description [IN] Offset from cached to uncached area. Can be negative if uncached area is before cached area. Table 4.14: IP_ConfigOffCached2Uncached() parameter list Additional information This function needs to be called in case the microcontroller is utilizing a MMU setup with the data area that is used by default being cached. In this case the stack needs to know where it can bypass the cache to write hardware related data such as driver descriptors that will be accessed by a DMA. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 62 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.15 IP_DisableIPRxChecksum() Description Disables checksum verification of the checksum in the IP header for incoming packets. Prototype void IP_DisableIPRxChecksum ( U8 IFace ); Parameter Parameter IFace Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. Table 4.15: IP_DisableIPRxChecksum() parameter list Additional information In a typical network typically all data contained in a transferred frame has already been verified by the hardware checking the trasmitted frames checksum and it is unlikely that data within this frame is corrupted if the frame checksum was verified as being correct. Therefore for optimization reasons the checksum calculation might be disabled. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 63 4.2.16 IP_DNS_GetServer() Description Retrieves the first DNS server configured of the first interface. Prototype U32 IP_DNS_GetServer ( void ); Return value First DNS server address of first interface. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 64 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.17 IP_DNS_GetServerEx() Description Retrieves a DNS server configured for an interface. Prototype void IP_DNS_GetServerEx ( U8 IFace, U8 DNSIndex, U8 *pAddr, int *pAddrLen ); Parameter Parameter IFace DNSIndex pAddr pAddrLen Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces. -1 when out of range. [IN] Zero-based index of the server to retrieve from interface. -1 when out of range. [OUT] Pointer to U32 variable (for IPv4) to store the DNS addr. [OUT] Length of DNS addr. in bytes. Typically 4 for IPv4. Table 4.16: IP_DNS_GetServerEx() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 65 4.2.18 IP_DNS_SetMaxTTL() Description Sets the maximum Time To Live (TTL) of a DNS entry in seconds. Prototype void IP_DNS_SetMaxTTL( U32 TTL ); Parameter Parameter TTL Description [IN] Maximum TTL of a DNS entry in seconds. Table 4.17: IP_DNS_SetMaxTTL() parameter list Additional information The real TTL is the minimum of TTL and the TTL specified by the DNS server for the entry. The embOS/IP default for the maximum TTL of an DNS entry is 600 seconds. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 66 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.19 IP_DNS_SetServer() Description Sets the DNS server that should be used. Prototype void IP_DNS_SetServer ( U32 DNSServerAddr ); Parameter Parameter DNSServerAddr Description [IN] Address of DNS server. Table 4.18: IP_DNS_SetServer() parameter list Additional information If a DHCP server is used for configuring your target, IP_DNS_SetServer() should not be called. The DNS server settings are normally part of the DHCP configuration setup. The DNS server has to be defined before calling gethostbyname() to resolve an internet address. Refer to gethostbyname() on page 148 for detailed information about resolving an internet address. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 67 4.2.20 IP_DNS_SetServerEx() Description Sets one DNS server for an interface. Prototype void IP_DNS_SetServerEx ( U8 IFace, U8 DNSIndex, const U8 *pDNSAddr, int AddrLen ); Parameter Parameter IFace DNSIndex pDNSAddr AddrLen Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. [IN] Zero-based DNS server index of the interface. [IN] Pointer to memory location holding the DNS addr. to set. Typically an 4-byte IP addr. [IN] Length of IP addr. of server. Typically 4-bytes. Table 4.19: IP_DNS_SetServerEx() parameter list Additional information If a DHCP server is used for configuring your target, IP_DNS_SetServerEx() should not be called. The DNS server settings are normally part of the DHCP configuration setup. The DNS server has to be defined before calling gethostbyname() to resolve an internet address. Refer to gethostbyname() on page 148 for detailed information about resolving an internet address. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 68 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.21 IP_EnableIPRxChecksum() Description Enables checksum verification of the checksum in the IP header for incoming packets. Prototype void IP_EnableIPRxChecksum ( U8 IFace ); Parameter Parameter IFace Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. Table 4.20: IP_EnableIPRxChecksum() parameter list Additional information In a typical network typically all data contained in a transferred frame has already been verified by the hardware checking the trasmitted frames checksum and it is unlikely that data within this frame is corrupted if the frame checksum was verified as being correct. Therefore for optimization reasons the checksum calculation might be disabled. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 69 4.2.22 IP_GetPrimaryIFace() Description Retrieves the currently set primary interface index of the system. Prototype int IP_GetPrimaryIFace( void ); Return value Primary interface index set in the system. If not previously configured with IP_SetPrimaryIFace() on page 84 the default is 0. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 70 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.23 IP_ICMP_Add() Description Adds ICMP to the stack. Prototype void IP_ICMP_Add ( void ); Additional information IP_ICMP_Add() adds ICMP to the stack. The function should be called during the initialization of the stack. In the supplied sample configuration files IP_ICMP_Add() is called from IP_X_Config(). If you remove the call of IP_ICMP_Add(), the ICMP code will not be available in your application. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 71 4.2.24 IP_ICMP_DisableRxChecksum() Description Disables checksum verification of the checksum in the ICMP header for incoming packets. Prototype void IP_ICMP_DisableRxChecksum ( U8 IFace ); Parameter Parameter IFace Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. Table 4.21: IP_ICMP_DisableRxChecksum() parameter list Additional information In a typical network typically all data contained in a transferred frame has already been verified by the hardware checking the trasmitted frames checksum and it is unlikely that data within this frame is corrupted if the frame checksum was verified as being correct. Therefore for optimization reasons the checksum calculation might be disabled. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 72 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.25 IP_ICMP_EnableRxChecksum() Description Enables checksum verification of the checksum in the ICMP header for incoming packets. Prototype void IP_ICMP_EnableRxChecksum ( U8 IFace ); Parameter Parameter IFace Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. Table 4.22: IP_ICMP_EnableRxChecksum() parameter list Additional information In a typical network typically all data contained in a transferred frame has already been verified by the hardware checking the trasmitted frames checksum and it is unlikely that data within this frame is corrupted if the frame checksum was verified as being correct. Therefore for optimization reasons the checksum calculation might be disabled. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 73 4.2.26 IP_IGMP_Add() Description Adds IGMP to the stack. Prototype void IP_IGMP_Add ( void ); Additional information IP_IGMP_Add() adds IGMP (Internet Group Management Protocol) to the stack. The function should be either called during the initialization of the stack by adding it to your IP_X_Config() or should be called after IP_Init(). If you remove the call of IP_IGMP_Add(), the ICMP code will not be available in your application. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 74 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.27 IP_IGMP_JoinGroup() Description Joins an IGMP group. Prototype void IP_IGMP_JoinGroup ( unsigned IFace, IP_ADDR GroupIP ); Parameter Parameter IFace GroupIP Description [IN] Zero-based index of available interfaces. [IN] IGMP group IP addr. Table 4.23: IP_IGMP_JoinGroup() parameter list Additional information Calling this function should be only done after IP_init() as we relay on an already configured HW addr. Multicast is a technique to distribute a packet to multiple receivers in a network by sending only one packet. Handling of who will receive the packet is not done by the sender but instead is done by network hardware such as routers or switched hubs that will dupplicate the packet and send it to everyone that participates the chosen group. The target does not actively participate by sending a join request. The network hardware periodically broadcasts membership querys throughout the network that have to be answered with a membership report in case we want to participate in the queried group. Example /* Excerpt from IP.h */ #define IP_IGMP_MCAST_ALLHOSTS_GROUP #define IP_IGMP_MCAST_ALLRPTS_GROUP 0xE0000001uL 0xE0000016uL // 224.0.0.1 // 224.0.0.22, IGMPv3 /* Excerpt from the UPnP code */ #define SSDP_IP 0xEFFFFFFA // Simple service discovery protocol IP, 239.255.255.250 IP_IGMP_Add(); // IGMP is needed for UPnP // // Join IGMP ALLHOSTS group and IGMP group for SSDP // IP_IGMP_JoinGroup(0, IP_IGMP_MCAST_ALLHOSTS_GROUP); IP_IGMP_JoinGroup(0, SSDP_IP); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 75 4.2.28 IP_IGMP_LeaveGroup() Description Leaves an IGMP group. Prototype void IP_IGMP_LeaveGroup ( unsigned IFace, IP_ADDR GroupIP ); Parameter Parameter IFace GroupIP Description [IN] Zero-based index of available interfaces. [IN] IGMP group IP addr. Table 4.24: IP_IGMP_LeaveGroup() parameter list Additional information The target does not actively participate by sending a leave request. Instead the target will change its filters to no longer receiving IGMP membership querys and will then be removed from the list of participants of the network hardware after a timeout. Example /* Excerpt from IP.h */ #define IP_IGMP_MCAST_ALLHOSTS_GROUP #define IP_IGMP_MCAST_ALLRPTS_GROUP 0xE0000001uL 0xE0000016uL // 224.0.0.1 // 224.0.0.22, IGMPv3 /* Sample for leaving IGMP groups used for UPnP */ #define SSDP_IP 0xEFFFFFFA // Simple service discovery protocol IP, 239.255.255.250 // // Leave IGMP ALLHOSTS group and IGMP group for SSDP // IP_IGMP_LeaveGroup(0, IP_IGMP_MCAST_ALLHOSTS_GROUP); IP_IGMP_LeaveGroup(0, SSDP_IP); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 76 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.29 IP_PHY_DisableCheck() Description Disables PHY checks. Prototype void IP_PHY_DisableCheck ( U32 Mask ); Parameter Parameter Mask Description Bitmask of checks to disable. At this time only the following values are accepted: 0: All checks active. 1: Disable PHY ID check. Table 4.25: IP_PHY_DisableCheck() parameter list Additional information The generic PHY module is designed to work with fully IEEE 802.3u compliant Ethernet PHYs. Almost any PHY is compatible to this minimum standard. However there are PHYs that state in documentation that they are compliant but lack some of the standard registers that have to be present due to this standard. The PHY initialization may fail due to the lack of these registers if when they are part of the functional validation. Using this function some checks can be disabled if they do not work with the PHY you are using. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 77 4.2.30 IP_RAW_Add() Description Adds RAW socket support to the stack. Prototype void IP_RAW_Add ( void ); Additional information IP_RAW_Add() adds RAW socket support to the stack. The function should be called during the initialization of the stack. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 78 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.31 IP_SetAddrMask() Description Sets the IP address and subnet mask of the first interface of the stack (interface 0). Prototype void IP_SetAddrMask ( U32 Addr, U32 Mask ); Parameter Parameter Addr Mask Description [IN] 4-byte IPv4 address. [IN] Subnet mask. Table 4.26: IP_SetAddrMask() parameter list Additional information The address mask should only be set if no DHCP server is used to obtain IP address, subnet mask and default gateway. Refer to chapter DHCP client on page 223 for detailed information about the usage of the embOS/IP DHCP client. Example IP_SetAddrMask(0xC0A80505, 0xFFFF0000); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP // IP: 192.168.5.5 // Subnet mask: 255.255.0.0 (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 79 4.2.32 IP_SetAddrMaskEx() Description Sets the IP address and subnet mask of an interface. Prototype void IP_SetAddrMaskEx ( U8 IFace, U32 Addr, U32 Mask ); Parameter Parameter IFace Addr Mask Description [IN] Interface Id. [IN] 4-byte IPv4 address. [IN] Subnet mask. Table 4.27: IP_SetAddrMaskEx() parameter list Additional information The address mask should only be set if no DHCP server is used to obtain IP address, subnet mask and default gateway. Refer to chapter DHCP client on page 223 for detailed information about the usage of the embOS/IP DHCP client. Example IP_SetAddrMaskEx(0, 0xC0A80505, 0xFFFF0000); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP // Interface: 0 // IP: 192.168.5.5 // Subnet mask: 255.255.0.0 (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 80 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.33 IP_SetGWAddr() Description Sets the default gateway address of the selected interface. Prototype void IP_SetGWAddr ( U8 IFace, U32 Addr ); Parameter Parameter IFace Addr Description [IN] Interface Id. [IN] 4-byte gateway address. Table 4.28: IP_SetGWAddrEx() parameter list Additional information The address mask should only be set if no DHCP server is used to obtain IP address, subnet mask and default gateway. Refer to chapter DHCP client on page 223 for detailed information about the usage of the embOS/IP DHCP client. Example IP_SetGWAddr(0, 0xC0A80101); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP // Interface: 0 // IPv4 address of the GW: 192.168.1.1 (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 81 4.2.34 IP_SetHWAddr() Description Sets the Media Access Control address (MAC) of the first interface (interface 0). Prototype void IP_SetHWAddr( const U8 * pHWAddr ); Parameter Parameter pHWAddr Description [IN] 6-byte MAC address. Table 4.29: IP_SetHWAddr() parameter list Additional information The MAC address needs to be unique for production units. Example IP_SetHWAddr("\x00\x22\x33\x44\x55\x66"); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 82 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.35 IP_SetHWAddrEx() Description Sets the Media Access Control address (MAC) of the selected interface. Prototype void IP_SetHWAddr( const U8 * pHWAddr ); Parameter Parameter pHWAddr Description [IN] 6-byte MAC address. Table 4.30: IP_SetHWAddrEx() parameter list Additional information The MAC address needs to be unique for production units. Example IP_SetHWAddrEx(0, "\x00\x22\x33\x44\x55\x66"); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 83 4.2.36 IP_SetMTU() Description Allows to set the Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) of the selected interface. Prototype void IP_SetMTU( U8 IFace, U32 Mtu ); Parameter Parameter IFace Mtu Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces. [IN] Size of maximum transmission unit in bytes. Table 4.31: IP_SetMTU() parameter list Additional information The Maximum Transmission Unit is the MTU from an IP standpoint, so the size of the IP-packet without local net header. A typical value for ethernet is 1500, since the maximum size of an Ethernet packet is 1518 bytes. Since Ethernet uses 12 bytes for MAC addresses, 2 bytes for type and 4 bytes for CRC, 1500 bytes "payload" remain. The minimum size of the MTU is 576 according to RFC 879. Refer to [RFC 879] - TCP - The TCP Maximum Segment Size and Related Topics for more information about the MTU. A smaller MTU size is effective for TCP connections only, it does not affect UDP connections. All TCP connections are guaranteed to work with any MTU in the permitted range of 576 - 1500 bytes. The advantage of a smaller MTU is that smaller packets are sent in TCP communication, resulting in reduced RAM requirements, especially if the window size is also reduced. The disadvantage is a loss of communication speed. Note: In the supplied embOS/IP example configurations, the MTU is used to configure the maximum packet size that the stack can handle. This means that if you lower the MTU (for example, set it to 576 bytes), the stack can only handle packets up to that size. If you plan to use larger UDP packets, change the configuration according to your requirements. For further information about the configuration of the stack, refer to Configuring embOS/IP on page 325. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 84 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.37 IP_SetPrimaryIFace() Description Allows to set the primary interface index of the system Prototype int IP_SetPrimaryIFace( int IFaceId ); Parameter Parameter IFaceId Description [IN] Zero-based interface index to use as primary interface of the system. Table 4.32: IP_SetPrimaryIFace() parameter list Return value 0: O.K. < 0: Error, interface index might not be valid. Additional information The primary interface will be be handled with priority in several situations e.g. finding a suitable DNS server to resolve a host name. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 85 4.2.38 IP_SetSupportedDuplexModes() Description Allows to set the allowed Duplex modes. Prototype int IP_SetSupportedDuplexModes( unsigned Unit, unsigned DuplexMode); Parameter Parameter Unit DuplexMode Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces. [IN] OR-combination of one or more of the following valid values. Table 4.33: IP_SetSupportedDuplexModes() parameter list Valid values for parameter DuplexMode Value IP_PHY_MODE_10_HALF IP_PHY_MODE_10_FULL IP_PHY_MODE_100_HALF IP_PHY_MODE_100_FULL UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP Description Support Support Support Support 10 Mbit half-duplex 10 Mbit full-duplex 100 Mbit half-duplex 100 Mbit full-duplex (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 86 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.39 IP_SetTTL() Description Sets the default value for the Time-To-Live IP header field. Prototype void IP_SetTTL ( int v ); Parameter Parameter v Description [IN] Time-To-Live value. Table 4.34: IP_SetTTL() parameter list Additional information By default, the TTL (Time-To-Live) is 64. The TTL field length of the IP is 8 bits. The maximum value of the TTL field is therefore 255. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 87 4.2.40 IP_SOCKET_ConfigSelectMultiplicator() Description Allows to configure the multiplicator for the timeout parameter of select() on page 159. Prototype void IP_SOCKET_ConfigSelectMultiplicator( U32 v ); Parameter Parameter v Description [IN] Multiplicator to be used. Default 1. Table 4.35: IP_SOCKET_ConfigSelectMultiplicator() parameter list Additional information By default the select() timeout is given in ticks of 1 ms. The UNIX standard takes the timeout in a structue including seconds. The multiplicator can be configured but as it is more common for an embedded system we will stick to units of 1 tick (typically 1 ms) for the default. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 88 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.41 IP_SOCKET_SetDefaultOptions() Description Allows to set the maximum transmission unit (MTU) of an interface. Prototype void IP_SOCKET_SetDefaultOptions ( U16 v ); Parameter Parameter v Description [IN] Socket options which should be enabled. By default, keepalive (SO_KEEPALIVE) socket option is enabled. Refer to setsockopt() on page 164 for a list of supported socket options. Table 4.36: IP_SOCKET_SetDefaultOptions() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 89 4.2.42 IP_SOCKET_SetLimit() Description Sets the maximum number of available sockets. Prototype void IP_SOCKET_SetLimit ( unsigned Limit ); Parameter Parameter Limit Description [IN] Sets a limit on number of sockets which can be created. The embOS/IP default is 0 which means that no limit is set. Table 4.37: IP_SOCKET_SetLimit() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 90 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.43 IP_TCP_Add() Description Adds TCP to the stack. Prototype void IP_TCP_Add ( void ); Additional information IP_TCP_Add() adds TCP to the stack. The function should be called during the initialization of the stack. In the supplied sample configuration files IP_TCP_Add() is called from IP_X_Config(). If you remove the call of IP_TCP_Add(), the TCP code will not be available in your application. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 91 4.2.44 IP_TCP_DisableRxChecksum() Description Disables checksum verification of the checksum in the TCP header for incoming packets. Prototype void IP_TCP_DisableRxChecksum ( U8 IFace ); Parameter Parameter IFace Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. Table 4.38: IP_TCP_DisableRxChecksum() parameter list Additional information In a typical network typically all data contained in a transferred frame has already been verified by the hardware checking the trasmitted frames checksum and it is unlikely that data within this frame is corrupted if the frame checksum was verified as being correct. Therefore for optimization reasons the checksum calculation might be disabled. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 92 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.45 IP_TCP_EnableRxChecksum() Description Enables checksum verification of the checksum in the TCP header for incoming packets. Prototype void IP_TCP_EnableRxChecksum ( U8 IFace ); Parameter Parameter IFace Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. Table 4.39: IP_TCP_EnableRxChecksum() parameter list Additional information In a typical network typically all data contained in a transferred frame has already been verified by the hardware checking the trasmitted frames checksum and it is unlikely that data within this frame is corrupted if the frame checksum was verified as being correct. Therefore for optimization reasons the checksum calculation might be disabled. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 93 4.2.46 IP_TCP_Set2MSLDelay() Description Sets the maximum segment lifetime (MSL). Prototype void IP_TCP_Set2MSLDelay( unsigned v ); Parameter Parameter v Description [IN] Maximum segment lifetime. The embOS/IP default is 2 seconds. Table 4.40: IP_TCP_Set2MSLDelay() parameter list Additional information The maximum segment lifetime is the amount of time any segment can exist in the network before being discarded. This time limit is constricted. When TCP performs an active close the connection must stay in TIME_WAIT (2MSL) state for twice the MSL after sending the final ACK. Refer to [RFC 793] - TCP - Transmission Control Protocol for more information about TCP states. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 94 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.47 IP_TCP_SetConnKeepaliveOpt() Description Sets the keepalive options. Prototype void IP_TCP_SetConnKeepaliveOpt( U32 U32 U32 U32 Init, Idle, Period, MaxRep ); Parameter Parameter Init Idle Period MaxRep Description [IN] Maximum time after TCP-connection open (response to SYN) in ms in case no data transfer takes place. The embOS/IP default is 10 seconds. [IN] Time of TCP-inactivity before first keepalive probe is sent in ms. The embOS/IP default is 10 seconds. [IN] Time of TCP-inactivity between keepalive probes in ms. The embOS/IP default is 10 seconds. [IN] Number of keepalive probes before we give up and close the connection. The embOS/IP default is 8 repetitions. Table 4.41: IP_TCP_SetConnKeepaliveOpt() parameter list Additional information Keepalives are not part of the TCP specification, since they can cause good connections to be dropped during transient failures. For example, if the keepalive probes are sent during the time that an intermediate router has crashed and is rebooting, TCP will think that the client's host has crashed, which is not what has happened. Nevertheless, the keepalive feature is very useful for embedded server applications that might tie up resources on behalf of a client, and want to know if the client host crashes. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 95 4.2.48 IP_TCP_SetRetransDelayRange() Description Sets the retransmission delay range. Prototype void IP_TCP_SetRetransDelayRange( unsigned RetransDelayMin, unsigned RetransDelayMax ); Parameter Parameter RetransDelayMin RetransDelayMax Description [IN] Minimum time before first retransmission. The embOS/IP default is 200 ms. [IN] Maximum time to wait before a retransmission. The embOS/IP default is 5 seconds. Table 4.42: IP_TCP_SetRetransDelayRange() parameter list Additional information TCP is a reliable transport layer. One of the ways it provides reliability is for each end to acknowledge the data it receives from the communication partner. But data segments and acknowledgments can get lost. TCP handles this by setting a timeout when it sends data, and if the data is not acknowledged when the timeout expires, it retransmits the data. The timeout and retransmission is the measurement of the round-trip time (RTT) experienced on a given connection. The RTT can change over time, as routes might change and as network traffic changes, and TCP should track these changes and modify its timeout accordingly. IP_TCP_SetRetransDelayRange() should be called if the default limits are not sufficient for your application. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 96 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.49 IP_UDP_Add() Description Adds UDP to the stack. Prototype void IP_UDP_Add ( void ); Additional information IP_UDP_Add() adds UDP to the stack. The function should be called during the initialization of the stack. In the supplied sample configuration files IP_UDP_Add() is called from IP_X_Config(). If you remove the call of IP_UDP_Add(), the UDP code will not be available in your application. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 97 4.2.50 IP_UDP_DisableRxChecksum() Description Disables checksum verification of the checksum in the UDP header for incoming packets. Prototype void IP_UDP_DisableRxChecksum ( U8 IFace ); Parameter Parameter IFace Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. Table 4.43: IP_UDP_DisableRxChecksum() parameter list Additional information In a typical network typically all data contained in a transferred frame has already been verified by the hardware checking the trasmitted frames checksum and it is unlikely that data within this frame is corrupted if the frame checksum was verified as being correct. Therefore for optimization reasons the checksum calculation might be disabled. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 98 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.2.51 IP_UDP_EnableRxChecksum() Description Enables checksum verification of the checksum in the TCP header for incoming packets. Prototype void IP_TCP_EnableRxChecksum ( U8 IFace ); Parameter Parameter IFace Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. Table 4.44: IP_TCP_EnableRxChecksum() parameter list Additional information In a typical network typically all data contained in a transferred frame has already been verified by the hardware checking the trasmitted frames checksum and it is unlikely that data within this frame is corrupted if the frame checksum was verified as being correct. Therefore for optimization reasons the checksum calculation might be disabled. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 99 4.3 Management functions UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 100 CHAPTER 4 4.3.1 Core functions IP_DeInit() Description De-initializes the TCP/IP stack. Prototype void IP_DeInit ( void ); Additional information IP_DeInit() de-initializes the IP stack. This function should be the very last embOS/ IP function called and is typically not needed if you do not need to shutdown your whole application for a special reason. De-initialization should be done in the exact reversed order of intialization. This means terminating any created task that uses the IP API, terminating the IP_RxTask (if used), terminating the IP_Task and finally calling IP_DeInit() to close down the stack. The whole de-initialization should be done with Ethernet interrupts disabled and task switching disabled to prevent the de-initialization being interrupted by an Ethernet event. De-init has to be supported by the driver as well. If your driver does not yet support IP_DeInit() you will end up in IP_Panic() . Please contact our support address and ask for IP_DeInit() support to be added to your driver. Example #include "IP.h" void main(void) { IP_Init(); // // Create IP tasks and use the stack // ... // // Disable Ethernet interrupt // OS_EnterRegion(); // Prevent task switching // // Terminate all application tasks that make use of the IP API // // // Terminate IP_RxTask first (if used) and IP_Task // IP_DeInit(); OS_LeaveRegion(); // Allow task switching } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 101 4.3.2 IP_Init() Description Initializes the TCP/IP stack. Prototype void IP_Init ( void ); Additional information IP_Init() initializes the IP stack and creates resources required for an OS integration. This function must be called before any other embOS/IP function is called. Example #include "IP.h" void main(void) { IP_Init(); /* * Use the stack */ } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 102 CHAPTER 4 4.3.3 Core functions IP_Task() Description Main task for starting the stack. After startup, it settles into a loop handling received packets. This loop sleeps until a packet has been queued in the receive queue; then it should be awakened by the driver which queued the packet. Prototype void IP_Task ( void ); Additional information Implementing this task is the simplest way to include embOS/IP into your project. Typical stack usage is approximately 440 bytes. To be on the safe side set the size of the task stack to 1024 bytes. Note: The priority of task IP_Task should be higher then the priority of an application task which uses the stack. Example #include #include #include #include #include static static static static "RTOS.h" "BSP.h" "IP.h" "IP_Int.h" OS_STACKPTR int _Stack0[512]; OS_TASK _TCB0; OS_STACKPTR int _IPStack[1024]; OS_TASK _IPTCB; // // // // Task stacks Task-control-blocks Task stacks Task-control-blocks /********************************************************************* * * MainTask */ void MainTask(void); void MainTask(void) { printf("****************************************\nProgram start\n"); IP_Init(); OS_SetPriority(OS_GetTaskID(), 255); // This task has highest prio! OS_CREATETASK(&_IPTCB, "IP_Task", IP_Task, 150, _IPStack); while (1) { BSP_ToggleLED(1); OS_Delay (200); } } /********************************************************** * * main */ void main(void) { BSP_Init(); BSP_SetLED(0); OS_IncDI(); /* Initially disable interrupts */ OS_InitKern(); /* initialize OS */ OS_InitHW(); /* initialize Hardware for OS */ OS_CREATETASK(&_TCB0, "MainTask", MainTask, 100, _Stack0); OS_Start(); } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 103 4.3.4 IP_RxTask() Description The task reads all available packets from the network interface and sleeps until a new packet is received. Prototype void IP_RxTask ( void ); Additional information This task is optional. Refer to Tasks and interrupt usage on page 21 for detailed information about the task and interrupt handling of embOS/IP. Typical stack usage is approximately 150 bytes. To be on the safe side set the size of the task stack to 1024 bytes. Note: The priority of task IP_RxTask() should be higher then the priority of an application task which uses the stack. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 104 CHAPTER 4 4.3.5 Core functions IP_Exec() Description Checks if the driver has received a packet and handles timers. Prototype void IP_Exec ( void ); Additional information This function is normally called from an endless loop in IP_Task(). If no particular IP task is implemented in your project, IP_Exec() should be called regularly. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 105 4.4 Network interface configuration and handling functions UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 106 CHAPTER 4 4.4.1 Core functions IP_NI_ConfigPHYAddr() Description Configures the PHY address. Prototype void IP_NI_ConfigPHYAddr ( unsigned Unit, U8 Addr ); Parameter Unit Addr Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces. [IN] 5-bit address. Table 4.45: IP_NI_ConfigPHYAddr() parameter list Additional information The PHY address is a 5-bit value. The available embOS/IP drivers try to detect the PHY address automatically, therefore this should not be called. If you use this function to set the address explicitly, the function must be called from within IP_X_Config(). Refer to IP_X_Configure() on page 326. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 107 4.4.2 IP_NI_ConfigPHYMode() Description Configures the PHY mode. Prototype void IP_NI_ConfigPHYMode ( unsigned Unit, U8 Mode ); Parameter Unit Mode Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces. [IN] The operating mode of the PHY. Table 4.46: IP_NI_ConfigPHYMode() parameter list Valid values for parameter Mode Value IP_PHY_MODE_MII IP_PHY_MODE_RMII Description Phy uses the Media Independent Interface (MII). Phy uses the Reduced Media Independent Interface (RMII). Additional information The PHY can be connected to the MAC via two different modes, MII or RMII. Refer to section MII / RMII: Interface between MAC and PHY on page 25 for detailed information about the differences of the MII and RMII modes. The selection which mode is used is normally done correctly by the hardware. The mode is typically sampled during power-on RESET. If you use this function to set the mode explicitly, the function must be called from within IP_X_Config(). Refer to IP_X_Configure() on page 326. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 108 CHAPTER 4 4.4.3 Core functions IP_NI_ConfigPoll() Description Select polled mode for the network interface. This should be used only if the network interface can not activate an ISR itself. Prototype void IP_NI_ConfigPoll( unsigned Unit ); Parameter Unit Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces. Table 4.47: IP_NI_ConfigPoll() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 109 4.4.4 IP_NI_ForceCaps() Description Allows to force capabilities to be set for an interface. Typically this is used to allow the checksum calculation capabilities to be set manually. Typically this is used to give the target a performance boost in high traffic applications on stable networks, where the occurence of wrong checksums is unlikely. Prototype void IP_NI_ForceCaps( U8 IFace, U8 CapsForcedMask, U8 CapsForcedValue ); Parameter IFace CapsForcedMask CapsForcedValue Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces. [IN] Capabilities mask. For a list of driver capabilities please refer to IP.h and look for the "Driver capabilities" section. [IN] Value mask for the capabilities to force. Table 4.48: IP_NI_ConfigPoll() parameter list Example Forcing the capability bits 0 to value '0' and bit 2 to value '1' for the first interface can be done as shown in the code example below: IP_NI_ForceCaps(0, 5, 4); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 110 CHAPTER 4 4.4.5 Core functions IP_NI_SetTxBufferSize() Description Sets the size of the Tx buffer of the network interface. Prototype int IP_NI_SetTxBufferSize ( unsigned Unit, U8 NumBytes ); Parameter Unit NumBytes Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces. [IN] Size of the Tx buffer (at least size of the MTU + 16 bytes for Ethernet.) Table 4.49: IP_NI_SetTxBufferSize() parameter list Return value -1: Not supported by the network interface driver. 0: OK 1: Error, called after driver initialization has been completed. Additional information The default Tx buffer size is 1536 bytes. It can be useful to reduce the buffer size on systems with less RAM and an application that uses a small MTU. According to RFC 576 bytes is the smallest possible MTU. The size of the Tx buffer should be at least MTU + 16 bytes for Ethernet header and footer. The function should be called in IP_X_Config(). Note: This function is not implemented in all network interface drivers, since not all Media Access Controllers (MAC) support variable buffer sizes. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 111 4.5 Other IP stack functions UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 112 CHAPTER 4 4.5.1 Core functions IP_AddAfterInitHook() Description Adds a hook to a callback that is executed at the end of IP_Init() to allow adding initializations to be executed right after the stack itself has been initialized and all API can be used. Prototype void IP_AddAfterInitHook ( IP_HOOK_AFTER_INIT *pHook, void (*pf)(void) ); Parameter Parameter pHook pf Description [IN] Pointer to static element of IP_HOOK_AFTER_INIT that can be internally used by the stack. [IN] Function pointer to the callback that will be executed. Table 4.50: IP_AddAfterInitHook() parameter list Additional information Adding a callback to be executed right after IP_Init() can be helpful for various things. For example this allows using a centralized initialization that is not located in the main routine that calls IP_Init() and has to make use of IP API that is only valid to be used after IP_Init(). Example // // Excerpt of content of IP_Config_*.c // static IP_HOOK_AFTER_INIT _Hook; static void _Connect(void) { ... } void IP_X_Config(void) { ... IP_AddAfterInitHook(&_Hook, _Connect); // Register _Connect() to be // executed at end of IP_Init() ... } // // Excerpt of content of main.c // void main(void) { ... IP_Init(); ... } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 113 4.5.2 IP_AddStateChangeHook() Description Adds a hook to a callback that is executed when the AdminState or HWState of an interface changes. Prototype void IP_AddStateChangeHook ( IP_HOOK_ON_STATE_CHANGE *pHook, void (*pf)( unsigned IFaceId, U8 AdminState, U8 HWState ) ); Parameter Parameter pHook pf Description [IN] Pointer to static element of IP_HOOK_ON_STATE_CHANGE that can be internally used by the stack. [IN] Function pointer to the callback that will be executed. Table 4.51: IP_AddStateChangeHook() parameter list Additional information A state change hook can be used to be notified about an interface has not been triggered by the application. Typical example would closes a dial-up connection and the application needs to get notified call a disconnect itself. Examples of this behavior can be found shipped with the stack. disconnect that be a peer that of this event to in the samples Example static IP_HOOK_ON_STATE_CHANGE _Hook; static void _OnChange(unsigned IFaceId, U8 AdminState, U8 HWState) { ... } void main(void) { ... IP_AddStateChangeHook(&_Hook, _OnChange); // Register _OnState() to be // executed when interface changes. // Connect dial-up interface. ... } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 114 CHAPTER 4 4.5.3 Core functions IP_Alloc() Description Thread safe memory allocation from IP stack memory pool. Prototype void * IP_Alloc ( U32 NumBytesReq ); Parameter Parameter NumBytesReq Description [IN] Number of bytes to allocate from IP stack memory. Table 4.52: IP_Alloc() parameter list Return value NULL: Error, unable to allocate memory. != NULL: Pointer to allocated memory block. Additional information Memory allocated with this function has to be freed with IP_Free() on page 118. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 115 4.5.4 IP_Connect() Description Calls a previously registered callback IP_SetIFaceConnectHook() on page 137. that has been registered with Prototype int IP_Connect ( unsigned IFaceId ); Parameter Parameter IFaceId Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. Table 4.53: IP_Connect() parameter list Return value 0 : O.K. or no callback set. Other: Error. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 116 CHAPTER 4 4.5.5 Core functions IP_Disconnect() Description Calls a previously registered callback IP_SetIFaceDisconnectHook() on page 138. that has been registered with Prototype int IP_Disconnect ( unsigned IFaceId ); Parameter Parameter IFaceId Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. Table 4.54: IP_Disconnect() parameter list Return value 0 : O.K. or no callback set. Other: Error. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 117 4.5.6 IP_Err2Str() Description Converts an error value to a printable string. Prototype const char * IP_Err2Str( int x ); Parameter Parameter x Description [IN] Error value other than 0. Table 4.55: IP_Err2Str() parameter list Return value String describing the value. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 118 CHAPTER 4 4.5.7 Core functions IP_Free() Description Thread safe memory free to IP stack memory pool. Prototype void IP_Free ( void *p ); Parameter Parameter p Description [IN] Pointer to memory block previously allocated with IP_Alloc() on page 114. Table 4.56: IP_Free() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 119 4.5.8 IP_GetAddrMask() Description Returns the IP address and the subnet mask of the device in network byte order (for example, 192.168.1.1 is returned as 0xc0a80101). Prototype void IP_GetAddrMask ( U8 IFace, U32 * pAddr, U32 * pMask ); Parameter Parameter IFace pAddr pMask Description [IN] Interface. [OUT] Address to store the IP address. [OUT] Address to store the subnet mask. Table 4.57: IP_GetAddrMask() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 120 CHAPTER 4 4.5.9 Core functions IP_GetCurrentLinkSpeed() Description Returns the current link speed of the first interface (interface ID '0'). Prototype int IP_GetCurrentLinkSpeed( void ); Return value 0: 1: 2: 3: link link link link speed speed speed speed unknown is 10 Mbit/s is 100 Mbit/s is 1000 Mbit/s Additional information The application should check if the link is up before a packet will be sent. It can take 2-3 seconds till the link is up if the PHY has been reset. Example // // Wait until link is up. // while (IP_GetCurrentLinkSpeed() == 0) { OS_IP_Delay(100); } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 121 4.5.10 IP_GetCurrentLinkSpeedEx() Description Returns the current link speed of the selected interface. Prototype int IP_GetCurrentLinkSpeedEx( unsigned IFaceId ); Parameter Parameter IFaceId Description [IN] Interface Id (zero-based). Table 4.58: IP_GetCurrentLinkSpeedEx() parameter list Return value 0: 1: 2: 3: link link link link speed speed speed speed unknown is 10 Mbit/s is 100 Mbit/s is 1000 Mbit/s Additional information The application should check if the link is up before a packet will be sent. It can take 2-3 seconds till the link is up if the PHY has been reset. Example // // Wait until link is up. // while (IP_GetCurrentLinkSpeedEx(0) == 0) { OS_IP_Delay(100); } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 122 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.5.11 IP_GetGWAddr() Description Returns the gateway address of the interface in network byte order (for example, 192.168.1.1 is returned as 0xc0a80101). Prototype U32 IP_GetGWAddr ( U8 IFace ); Parameter Parameter IFace Description [IN] Number of interface. Table 4.59: IP_GetGWAddr() parameter list Return value The gateway address of the interface. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 123 4.5.12 IP_GetHWAddr() Description Returns the hardware address (Media Access Control address) of the interface. Prototype void IP_GetHWAddr ( U8 IFace, U8 * pDest, unsigned Len ); Parameter Parameter IFace pDest Len Description [IN] Number of interface. [OUT] Address of the buffer to store the 48-bit MAC address. [IN] Size of the buffer. Should be at least 6-bytes. Table 4.60: IP_GetHWAddr() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 124 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.5.13 IP_GetIPAddr() Description Returns the IP address of the interface. Prototype U32 IP_GetIPAddr( U8 IFace ); Parameter Parameter IFace Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. Table 4.61: IP_GetIPAddr() parameter list Return value The IP address of the interface in host byte order (for example, 192.168.1.1 is returned as 0x0101a8c0 for a little endian target). Example void PrintIFaceIPAddr(void) { char ac[16]; U32 IPAddr; IPAddr = IP_GetIPAddr(0); IP_PrintIPAddr(ac, IPAddr, sizeof(ac)); printf("IP Addr: %s\n", ac); } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 125 4.5.14 IP_GetIPPacketInfo() Description Returns the start address of the data part of an IP packet. Prototype const char * IP_GetIPPacketInfo( IP_PACKET * pPacket ); Parameter Parameter pPacket Description [IN] Pointer to an IP_PACKET structure. Table 4.62: IP_GetIPPacketInfo() parameter list Return value 0 > Start address of the data part of the IP packet. 0 On failure. Example /********************************************************************* * * _pfOnRxICMP */ static int _pfOnRxICMP(IP_PACKET * pPacket) { const char * pData; pData = IP_GetIPPacketInfo(pPacket); if(*pData == 0x08) { printf("ICMP echo request received!\n"); } if(*pData == 0x00) { printf("ICMP echo reply received!\n"); } return 0; } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 126 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.5.15 IP_GetRawPacketInfo() Description Returns the start address of the raw data part of an IP packet. Prototype const char * IP_GetRawPacketInfo( IP_PACKET * pPacket, U16 * pNumBytes ); Parameter Parameter pPacket pNumBytes Description [IN] Pointer to an IP_PACKET structure. [OUT] Length of the packet. Table 4.63: IP_GetRawPacketInfo() parameter list Return value 0 > Start address of the raw data part of the IP packet. 0 On failure. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 127 4.5.16 IP_GetVersion() Description Returns the version number of the stack. Prototype int IP_GetVersion ( void ); Additional information The format of the version number: . For example, the return value 10201 means version 1.02a. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 128 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.5.17 IP_ICMP_SetRxHook() Description Sets a hook function which will be called if target receives a ping packet. Prototype void IP_ICMP_SetRxHook(IP_RX_HOOK * pf); Parameter Parameter pf Description Pointer to the callback function of type IP_RX_HOOK. Table 4.64: IP_ICMP_SetRxHook() parameter list Additional information The return value of the callback function is relevant for the further processing of the ICMP packet. A return value of 0 indicates that the stack has to process the packet after the callback has returned. A return value of 1 indicates that the packet will be freed directly after the callback has returned. The prototype for the callback function is defined as follows: typedef int (IP_RX_HOOK)(IP_PACKET * pPacket); Example /********************************************************************* * * Local defines, configurable * ********************************************************************** */ #define HOST_TO_PING 0xC0A80101 /********************************************************************* * * _pfOnRxICMP */ static int _pfOnRxICMP(IP_PACKET * pPacket) { const char * pData; pData = IP_GetIPPacketInfo(pPacket); if(*pData == 0x08) { printf("ICMP echo request received!\n"); } if(*pData == 0x00) { printf("ICMP echo reply received!\n"); } return 0; // Give packet back to the stack for further processing. } /********************************************************************* * * PingTask */ void PingTask(void) { int Seq; char * s = "This is a ICMP echo request!"; while (IP_IFaceIsReady() == 0) { OS_Delay(50); } IP_ICMP_SetRxHook(_pfOnRxICMP); Seq = 1111; while (1) { BSP_ToggleLED(1); OS_Delay (200); IP_SendPing(htonl(HOST_TO_PING), s, strlen(s), Seq++); } } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 129 4.5.18 IP_IFaceIsReady() Description Checks if the interface is ready for usage. Ready for usage means that the target has a physical link detected and a valid IP address. Prototype int IP_IFaceIsReady ( void ); Return value 1 network interface is ready. 0 network interface is not ready. Additional information The application has to check if the link is up before a packet will be sent and if the interface is configured. If a DHCP server is used for configuring your target, this function has to be called to assure that no application data will be sent before the target is ready. Example // // Wait until interface is ready. // while (IP_IFaceIsReady() == 0) { OS_Delay(100); } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 130 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.5.19 IP_IFaceIsReadyEx() Description Checks if the specified interface is ready for usage. Ready for usage means that the target has a physical link detected and a valid IP address. Prototype int IP_IFaceIsReadyEx ( unsigned IFaceId ); Parameter Parameter IFaceId Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. Table 4.65: IP_IFaceIsReadyEx() parameter list Return value 1 network interface is ready. 0 network interface is not ready. Additional information The application has to check if the link is up before a packet will be sent and if the interface is configured. If a DHCP server is used for configuring your target, this function has to be called to assure that no application data will be sent before the target is ready. Example // // Wait until second interface is ready. // while (IP_IFaceIsReadyEx(1) == 0) { OS_Delay(100); } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 131 4.5.20 IP_IsExpired() Description Checks if the given system timestamp has already expired. Prototype int IP_IsExpired ( I32 Time ); Parameter Parameter Time Description [IN] System timestamp as used by OS abstraction layer. Table 4.66: IP_IsExpired() parameter list Return value 1 Timestamp has expired. 0 Timestamp has not yet expired. Example U32 Timeout; // // Get current system time [ms] and timeout in one second. // Timeout = IP_OS_GET_TIME() + 1000; // // Wait until timeout expires. // do { OS_Delay(1); } while (IP_IsExpired(Timeout) == 0); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 132 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.5.21 IP_PrintIPAddr() Description Convert a 4-byte IP address to a dots-and-number string. Prototype int IP_PrintIPAddr( char * pDest, U32 IPAddr, int BufferSize ); Parameter Parameter pDest IPAddr Buffersize Description [OUT] Buffer to store the IP address string. [IN] IP address in host byte order. [IN] Size of buffer pDest. Should be 16 byte to store an IPv4 address. Table 4.67: IP_PrintIPAddr() parameter list Example void PrintIPAddr(void) { U32 IPAddr; char ac[16]; IPAddr = 0xC0A80801; // IP address: 192.168.8.1 IP_PrintIPAddr(ac, IPAddr, sizeof(ac)); printf("IP address: %s\n", ac); // Output: IP address: 192.168.8.1 } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 133 4.5.22 IP_ResolveHost() Description Resolve a host name string to its IP addr. by using a configured DNS server. Prototype int IP_ResolveHost( char *sHost, U32 *pIPAddr, U32 ms ); Parameter Parameter sHost pIPAddr ms Description [IN] Host name to resolve. [OUT] Pointer to where to store the resolved IP addr. [IN] Timeout in ms to wait for the DNS server to answer. Table 4.68: IP_ResolveHost() parameter list Return value 0 O.K., host name resolved. < 0 Error: Could not resolve host name. Additional information In contrast to the standard socket function gethostbyname(), this function allows resolving a host name in a thread safe way and should therefore be used whenever possible. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 134 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.5.23 IP_SendPacket() Description Sends a user defined packet on the interface. The packet will not be modified by the stack. IP_SendPacket() allocates a packet control block (IP_PACKET) and adds it to the out queue of the interface. Prototype int IP_SendPacket( unsigned IFace, void * pData, int NumBytes ); Parameter Parameter IFace pData Numbytes Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. [IN] Data packet that should be sent. [IN] Length of data which should be sent. Table 4.69: IP_SendPacket() parameter list Return value 0 -1 1 O.K., packet in out queue Error: Could not allocate a packet control block Error: Interface can not send UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 135 4.5.24 IP_SendPing() Description Sends a single "ping" (ICMP echo request) to the specified host. Prototype int IP_SendPing ( ip_addr host, char * data, unsigned datalen, U16 pingseq ); Parameter Parameter host data datalen pingseq Description [IN] [IN] [IN] [IN] 4-byte IPv4 address in network endian byte order. Ping data, NULL if do not care. Length of data to attach to ping request. Ping sequence number. Table 4.70: IP_SendPing() parameter list Return value Returns 0 if ICMP echo request was successfully sent, else negative error message. Additional information If you call this function with activated logging, the ICMP reply or (in case of an error) the error message will be sent to stdout. To enable the output of ICMP status messages, add the message type IP_MTYPE_ICMP to the log filter and the warn filter. Refer to Debugging on page 541 for detailed information about logging. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 136 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.5.25 IP_SendPingEx() Description Sends a single "ping" (ICMP echo request) to the specified host using the selected interface. Prototype int IP_SendPingEx ( U32 IFaceId, ip_addr host, char * data, unsigned datalen, U16 pingseq ); Parameter Parameter IFaceId host data datalen pingseq Description [IN] [IN] [IN] [IN] [IN] Interface index (zero-based). 4-byte IPv4 address in network endian byte order. Ping data, NULL if do not care. Length of data to attach to ping request. Ping sequence number. Table 4.71: IP_SendPingEx() parameter list Return value Returns 0 if ICMP echo request was successfully sent, else negative error message. Additional information If you call this function with activated logging, the ICMP reply or (in case of an error) the error message will be sent to stdout. To enable the output of ICMP status messages, add the message type IP_MTYPE_ICMP to the log filter and the warn filter. Refer to Debugging on page 541 for detailed information about logging. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 137 4.5.26 IP_SetIFaceConnectHook() Description Sets a callback for an interface that is executed when IP_Connect() on page 115 is called. Prototype void IP_SetIFaceConnectHook ( unsigned IFaceId, int (*pf) ( unsigned IFaceId ) ); Parameter Parameter IFaceId pf Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. [IN] Callback to set. Table 4.72: IP_SetIFaceConnectHook() parameter list Additional information Typically for a pure Ethernet interface this functionality is not needed. Typically it is used with dial-up interfaces or interfaces that need more configurations to be set by the application to work. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 138 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.5.27 IP_SetIFaceDisconnectHook() Description Sets a callback for an interface that is executed when IP_Disconnect() on page 116 is called. Prototype void IP_SetIFaceDisconnectHook ( unsigned IFaceId, int (*pf) ( unsigned IFaceId ) ); Parameter Parameter IFaceId pf Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. [IN] Callback to set. Table 4.73: IP_SetIFaceDisconnectHook() parameter list Additional information Typically for a pure Ethernet interface this functionality is not needed. Typically it is used with dial-up interfaces or interfaces that need more configurations to be set by the application to work. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 139 4.5.28 IP_SetRxHook() Description Sets a hook function which will be called if target receives a packet. Prototype void IP_SetRxHook(IP_RX_HOOK * pf); Parameter Parameter pf Description Pointer to the callback function of type IP_RX_HOOK. Table 4.74: IP_SetRxHook() parameter list Additional information The return value of the callback function is relevant for the further processing of the packet. A return value of 0 indicates that the stack has to process the packet after the callback has returned. A return value of >0 indicates that the packet will be freed directly after the callback has returned. The prototype for the callback function is defined as follows: typedef int (IP_RX_HOOK)(IP_PACKET * pPacket); Example Refer to IP_ICMP_SetRxHook() on page 128 for an example. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 140 CHAPTER 4 Core functions 4.6 Stack internal functions, variables and data-structures embOS/IP internal functions, variables and data-structures are not explained here as they are in no way required to use embOS/IP. Your application should not rely on any of the internal elements, as only the documented API functions are guaranteed to remain unchanged in future versions of embOS/IP. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 141 Chapter 5 Socket interface The embOS/IP socket API is almost compatible to the Berkeley socket interface. The Berkeley socket interface is the de facto standard for socket communication. All API functions are described in this chapter. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 142 5.1 CHAPTER 5 Socket interface API functions The table below lists the available socket API functions. Function accept() bind() closesocket() connect() gethostbyname() getpeername() getsockname() getsockopt() listen() recv() recvfrom() select() send() sendto() setsockopt() shutdown() socket() ntohl htonl htons ntohs Description Socket interface Accepts an incoming attempt on a socket. Assigns a name to an unnamed socket. Closes an existing socket. Establishes a connection to a socket. Resolves a host name into an IP address. Returns the IP addressing information of the connected host. Returns the current name for the specified socket. Returns the socket options. Marks a socket as accepting connections. Receives data from a connected socket. Receives a datagram and stores the source address. Checks if socket is ready. Sends data on a connected socket. Sends data to a specified address. Sets a socket option. Disables sends or receives on a socket. Creates an unbound socket. Helper macros Converts a unsigned long value from network to host byte order. Converts a unsigned long value from host byte order to network byte order. Converts a unsigned short value from host byte order to network byte order. Converts a unsigned short value from network to host byte order. Table 5.1: embOS/IP socket API function overview UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 143 5.1.1 accept() Description Accepts an incoming attempt on a socket. Prototype long accept ( long Socket, struct sockaddr * pAddr, int * pAddrLen ); Parameter Parameter Socket pAddr pAddrLen Description [IN] A descriptor identifying a socket. [OUT] An optional pointer to a buffer where the address of the connecting entity should be stored. The format of the address depends on the defined address family which was defined when the socket was created. [OUT] An optional pointer to an integer where the length of the received address should be stored. Just like the format of the address, the length of the address depends on the defined address family. Table 5.2: accept() parameter list Return value The returned value is a handle for the socket on which the actual connection will be made. -1 in case of an error. Additional information This call is used with connection-based socket types, currently with SOCK_STREAM. Refer to socket() on page 167 for more information about the different socket types. Before calling accept(), the used socket Socket has to be bound to an address with bind() and should be listening for connections after calling listen(). accept() extracts the first connection on the queue of pending connections, creates a new socket with the same properties of Socket and allocates a new file descriptor for the socket. If no pending connections are present on the queue, and the socket is not marked as non-blocking, accept() blocks the caller until a connection is present. If the socket is marked non-blocking and no pending connections are present on the queue, accept() returns and reports an error. The accepted socket is used to read and write data to and from the socket which is connected to this one; it is not used to accept more connections. The original socket Socket remains open for accepting further connections. The argument pAddr is a result parameter that is filled in with the address of the connecting entity as known to the communications layer. The exact format of the pAddr parameter is determined by the domain in which the communication is occurring. The pAddrLen is a value-result parameter. It should initially contain the amount of space pointed to by pAddr. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 144 CHAPTER 5 5.1.2 Socket interface bind() Description Assigns a name (port) to an unnamed socket. Prototype int bind ( long Socket, struct sockaddr * pAddr, int AddrLen ); Parameter Parameter Socket pAddr AddrLen Description [IN] A descriptor identifying a socket. [IN] A pointer to a buffer where the address of the connecting entity is stored. The format of the address depends on the defined address family which was defined when the socket was created. [IN] The length of the address. Table 5.3: bind() parameter list Return value 0 on success. -1 on failure. Additional information When a socket is created with socket() it exists in a name space (address family) but has no name assigned. bind() is used on an unconnected socket before subsequent calls to the connect() or listen() functions. bind() assigns the name pointed to by pAddr to the socket. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 145 5.1.3 closesocket() Description Closes an existing socket. Prototype int closesocket ( long Socket ); Parameter Parameter Socket Description [IN] Socket descriptor of the socket that should be closed. Table 5.4: closesocket() parameter list Return value 0 on success. -1 on failure. Additional information closesocket() closes a connection on the socket associated with Socket and the socket descriptor associated with Socket will be returned to the free socket descriptor pool. Once a socket is closed, no further socket calls should be made with it. If the socket promises reliable delivery of data and SO_LINGER is set, the system will block the caller on the closesocket() attempt until it is able to transmit the data or until it decides it is unable to deliver the information (a timeout period, termed the linger interval, is specified in the setsockopt() call when SO_LINGER is requested). If SO_LINGER is disabled and a closesocket() is issued, the system will process the close in a manner that allows the caller to continue as quickly as possible. If SO_LINGER is enabled with a timeout period of '0' and a closesocket() is issued, the system will perform a hard close. Example /********************************************************************* * * _CloseSocketGracefully() * * Function description * Wrapper for closesocket() with linger enabled to verify a gracefully * disconnect. */ static int _CloseSocketGracefully(long pConnectionInfo) { struct linger Linger; Linger.l_onoff = 1; // Enable linger for this socket. Linger.l_linger = 1; // Linger timeout in seconds setsockopt(hSocket, SOL_SOCKET, SO_LINGER, &Linger, sizeof(Linger)); return closesocket(hSocket); } /********************************************************************* * * _CloseSocketHard() * * Function description * Wrapper for closesocket() with linger option enabled to perform a hard close. */ static int _CloseSocketHard(long hSocket) { struct linger Linger; Linger.l_onoff = 1; // Enable linger for this socket. Linger.l_linger = 0; // Linger timeout in seconds setsockopt(hSocket, SOL_SOCKET, SO_LINGER, &Linger, sizeof(Linger)); return closesocket(hSocket); } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 146 CHAPTER 5 5.1.4 Socket interface connect() Description Establishes a connection to a socket. Prototype int connect ( long Socket, struct sockaddr * pAddr, int AddrLen ); Parameter Parameter Socket pAddr AddrLen Description [IN] A descriptor identifying an unconnected socket. [IN] A pointer to a buffer where the address of the connecting entity is stored. The format of the address depends on the defined address family which was defined when the socket was created. [IN] A pointer to an integer where the length of the received address is stored. Just like the format of the address, the length of the address depends on the defined address family. Table 5.5: connect() parameter list Return value 0 on success. -1 on failure. Additional information If Socket is of type SOCK_DGRAM or SOCK_RAW, then this call specifies the peer with which the socket is to be associated. pAddr defines the address to which datagrams are sent and the only address from which datagrams are received. To enable RAW socket support in the IP stack it is madatory to call IP_RAW_Add() on page 77 during initialization of the stack. If Socket is of type SOCK_STREAM, then this call attempts to make a connection to another socket. The other socket is specified by pAddr which is an address in the communications space of the socket. Each communications space interprets the pAddr parameter in its own way. Generally, stream sockets may successfully connect() only once; datagram sockets may use connect() multiple times to change their association. Datagram sockets may dissolve the association by connecting to an invalid address, such as a NULL address. If a connect is in progress and the socket is blocking, the connect call waits until connected or an error to happen. If the socket is non-blocking (refer to setsockopt() on page 164 for more information), 0 is returned. You can use the getsockopt() function (refer to getsockopt() on page 152) to determine the status of the connect attempt. Example #define SERVER_PORT #define SERVER_IP_ADDR 1234 0xC0A80101 // 192.168.1.1 /********************************************************************* * * _TCPClientTask * * Function description * Creates a connection to a given IP address, TCP port. */ static void _TCPClientTask(void) { UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 147 int TCPSockID; struct sockaddr_in ServerAddr; int ConnectStatus; // // Wait until link is up. This can take 2-3 seconds if PHY has been reset. // while (IP_GetCurrentLinkSpeed() == 0) { OS_Delay(100); } while(1) { TCPSockID = socket(AF_INET, SOCK_STREAM, 0); // Open socket if (TCPSockID < 0) { // Error, Could not get socket while (1) { OS_Delay(20); } } else { // // Connect to server // ServerAddr.sin_family = AF_INET; ServerAddr.sin_port = htons(SERVER_PORT); ServerAddr.sin_addr.s_addr = htonl(SERVER_IP_ADDR); ConnectStatus = connect(TCPSockID, (struct sockaddr *)&ServerAddr, sizeof(struct sockaddr_in)); if (ConnectStatus == 0) { // // Do something... // } } closesocket(TCPSockID); OS_Delay(50); } } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 148 CHAPTER 5 5.1.5 Socket interface gethostbyname() Description Resolve a host name into an IP address. Prototype struct hostent * gethostbyname (const char * name); Parameter Parameter Description [IN] Host name. name Table 5.6: gethostbyname() parameter list Return value On success, a pointer to a hostent structure is returned. Refer to Structure hostent on page 172 for detailed information about the hostent structure. On failure, it returns NULL. Additional information The function is called with a string containing the host name to be resolved as a fullyqualified domain name (for example, myhost.mydomain.com). Example static void _DNSClient() { struct hostent *pHostEnt; char **ps; char **ppAddr; // // Wait until link is up. // while (IP_IFaceIsReady() == 0) { OS_Delay(100); } while(1) { pHostEnt = gethostbyname("www.segger.com"); if (pHostEnt == NULL) { printf("Could not resolve host addr.\n"); break; } printf("h_name: %s\n", pHostEnt->h_name); // // Show aliases // ps = pHostEnt->h_aliases; for (;;) { char * s; s = *ps++; if (s == NULL) { break; } printf("h_aliases: %s\n", s); } // // Show IP addresses // ppAddr = pHostEnt->h_addr_list; for (;;) { U32 IPAddr; char * pAddr; char ac[16]; pAddr = *ppAddr++; if (pAddr == NULL) { break; } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 149 IPAddr = *(U32*)pAddr; IP_PrintIPAddr(ac, IPAddr, sizeof(ac)); printf("IP Addr: %s\n", ac); } } } Warning: gethostbyname() is not thread safe and should therefore only be used where absolutely necessary. If possible use the thread safe function IP_ResolveHost() instead. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 150 CHAPTER 5 5.1.6 Socket interface getpeername() Description Fills the passed structure sockaddr with the IP addressing information of the connected host. Prototype int getpeername ( long Socket, struct sockaddr * pAddr, struct int * pAddrLen ); Parameter Parameter Socket pAddr pAddrLen Description [IN] A descriptor identifying a socket. [OUT] A pointer to a structure of type sockaddr in which the IP address information of the connected host should be stored. [OUT] A pointer to an integer to store the length of socket address. Table 5.7: getpeername() parameter list Return value 0 on success. -1 on failure. Additional information Refer to Structure sockaddr on page 169 for detailed information about the structure sockaddr. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 151 5.1.7 getsockname() Description Returns the current name for the specified socket. Prototype int getsockname ( long Socket, struct sockaddr * pAddr ); Parameter Parameter Socket pAddr Description [IN] A descriptor identifying a socket. [OUT] A pointer to a structure of type sockaddr in which the IP address information of the connected host should be stored. Table 5.8: getsockname() parameter list Return value 0 on success. -1 on failure. Additional information Refer to Structure sockaddr on page 169 for detailed information about the structure sockaddr. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 152 CHAPTER 5 5.1.8 Socket interface getsockopt() Description Returns the options associated with a socket. Prototype int getsockopt ( long Socket, int Level, int Option, void * pData, int DataLen ); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 153 Parameter Parameter Socket Level Option pData DataLen Description [IN] A descriptor identifying a socket. [IN] Compatibility parameter for setsockopt() and getsockopt(). Use symbol SOL_SOCKET. [IN] The socket option which should be retrieved. [OUT] A pointer to the buffer in which the value of the requested option should be stored. [IN] The size of the data buffer. Table 5.9: getsockopt() parameter list Valid values for parameter Option Value Description Standard option flags. SO_ACCEPTCONN SO_DONTROUTE SO_KEEPALIVE SO_LINGER SO_NOSLOWSTART SO_TIMESTAMP Indicates that socket is in listen mode. Indicates that outgoing messages must bypass the standard routing facilities. Instead, messages are directed to the appropriate network interface according to the network portion of the destination address. Indicates that the periodic transmission of messages on a connected socket is enabled. If the connected party fails to respond to these messages, the connection is considered broken. Indicates that linger on close is enabled. Indicates that suppress slow start on this socket is enabled. Indicates that the TCP timestamp option is enabled. embOS/IP socket options. SO_ERROR SO_MYADDR SO_RCVTIMEO SO_NONBLOCK IP_HDRINCL Stores the latest socket error in pData and clears the error in socket structure. Stores the IP address of the used interface in pData. Returns the timeout for recv(). A return value of 0 indicates that no timeout is set. Gets sockets blocking status. Allows the caller to specify blocking or non-blocking IO that works the same as the other Boolean socket options. pData points to an integer value which will contain a non-zero value to set non-blocking IO or a 0 value to reset non-blocking IO. Checks if the IP header has to be included by the user for a RAW socket. Return value 0 on success. -1 on failure. Additional information getsockopt() retrieves the current value for a socket option associated with a socket of any type, in any state, and stores the result in pData. Options can exist at multiple protocol levels, but they are always present at the uppermost "socket" level. Options affect socket operations, such as the packet routing. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 154 CHAPTER 5 Socket interface The value associated with the selected option is returned in the buffer pData. The integer pointed to by DataLen should originally contain the size of this buffer; on return, it will be set to the size of the value returned. For SO_LINGER, this will be the size of a LINGER structure. For most other options, it will be the size of an integer. The application is responsible for allocating any memory space pointed to directly or indirectly by any of the parameters it specified. If the option was never set with setsockopt(), then getsockopt() returns the default value for the option. The option SO_ERROR returns 0 or the number of the socket error and clears the socket error. The following table lists the socket errors. Symbolic name Value IP_ERR_SEND_PENDING 1 IP_ERR_MISC -1 IP_ERR_TIMEDOUT IP_ERR_ISCONN -2 -3 IP_ERR_OP_NOT_SUPP -4 IP_ERR_CONN_ABORTED -5 IP_ERR_WOULD_BLOCK -6 IP_ERR_CONN_REFUSED IP_ERR_CONN_RESET IP_ERR_NOT_CONN IP_ERR_ALREADY -7 -8 -9 -10 IP_ERR_IN_VAL -11 IP_ERR_MSG_SIZE -12 IP_ERR_PIPE -13 IP_ERR_DEST_ADDR_REQ -14 IP_ERR_SHUTDOWN -15 IP_ERR_NO_PROTO_OPT -16 IP_ERR_NO_MEM -18 IP_ERR_ADDR_NOT_AVAIL -19 IP_ERR_ADDR_IN_USE -20 IP_ERR_IN_PROGRESS IP_ERR_NO_BUF -22 -23 IP_ERR_NOT_SOCK -24 IP_ERR_FAULT IP_ERR_NET_UNREACH IP_ERR_PARAM -25 -26 -27 IP_ERR_LOGIC -28 IP_ERR_NOMEM -29 Description Packet to send is not sent yet. Miscellaneous errors that do not have a specific error code. Operation timed out. Socket is already connected. Operation not supported for selected socket. Connection was aborted. Socket is in non-blocking state and the current operation would block the socket if not in non-blocking state. Connection refused by peer. Connection has been reset. Socket is not connected. Socket already is in the requested state. Passed value for configuration is not valid. Message is too big to send. Socket is not in the correct state for this operation. Destination addr. has not been specified. Connection has been closed as soon as all data has been received upon a FIN request. Unknown socket option for setsockopt() or getsockopt(). Not enough memory in the memory pool. No known path to send to the specified addr. Socket already has a connection to this addr. and port or is already bound to this addr. Operation is still in progress. No internal buffer was available. Socket has not been opened or has already been closed Generic error for a failed operation. No path to the desired network available. Invalid parameter to function. Logical error that should not have happened. System error: No memory for requested operation. Table 5.10: embOS/IP socket error types UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 155 Symbolic name Value IP_ERR_NOBUFFER -30 IP_ERR_RESOURCE -31 IP_ERR_BAD_STATE IP_ERR_TIMEOUT IP_ERR_NO_ROUTE -32 -33 -36 Description System error: No internal buffer available for the requested operation. System error: Not enough free resources available for the requested operation. Socket is in an unexpected state. Requested operation timed out. Net error: Destination is unreachable. Table 5.10: embOS/IP socket error types UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 156 CHAPTER 5 5.1.9 Socket interface listen() Description Prepares the socket to accept connections. Prototype int listen ( long Socket, int Backlog ); Parameter Parameter Socket Backlog Description [IN] Socket descriptor of an unconnected socket. [IN] Backlog for incoming connections. Defines the maximum length of the queue of pending connections. Table 5.11: listen() parameter list Return value On success 0. On failure, it returns -1. Additional information The listen() call applies only to sockets of type SOCK_STREAM. If a connection request arrives when the queue is full, the client will receive an error with an indication of ECONNREFUSED. Example /********************************************************************* * * _ListenAtTcpAddr * * Function description * Starts listening at the given TCP port. */ static int _ListenAtTcpAddr(U16 Port) { int Sock; struct sockaddr_in Addr; Sock = socket(AF_INET, SOCK_STREAM, 0); memset(&Addr, 0, sizeof(Addr)); Addr.sin_family = AF_INET; Addr.sin_port = htons(Port); Addr.sin_addr.s_addr = INADDR_ANY; bind(Sock, (struct sockaddr *)&Addr, sizeof(Addr)); listen(Sock, 1); return Sock; } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 157 5.1.10 recv() Description Receives data from a connected socket. Prototype int recv ( long Socket, char * pRecv, int Length, int Flags ); Parameter Parameter Socket pRecv Length Flags Description [IN] A descriptor identifying a socket. [OUT] A pointer to a buffer for incoming data. [IN] The length of buffer pRecv in bytes. [IN] OR-combination of one or more of the following valid values. Table 5.12: recv() parameter list Valid values for parameter Flag Value MSG_PEEK Description "Peek" at the data present on the socket; the data are returned, but not consumed, so that a subsequent receive operation will see the same data. Return value If no error occurs, recv() returns the number of bytes received. If the connection has been gracefully closed, the return value is zero. Otherwise, -1 is returned, and a specific error code can be retrieved by calling getsockopt(). Refer to getsockopt() on page 152 for detailed information. Additional information If a message is too long to fit in the supplied buffer, excess bytes may be discarded depending on the type of socket the message is received from. Refer to connect() on page 146 for more information about the different types of sockets. You can only use the recv() function on a connected socket. To receive data on a socket, whether it is in a connected state or not refer to recvfrom() on page 158. If no messages are available at the socket and the socket is blocking, the receive call waits for a message to arrive. If the socket is non-blocking (refer to setsockopt() on page 164 for more information), -1 is returned. You can use the select() function to determine when more data arrives. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 158 CHAPTER 5 Socket interface 5.1.11 recvfrom() Description Receives a datagram and stores the source address. Prototype int recvfrom ( long char * int int struct sockaddr * int * Socket, pRecv, Length, Flags, pAddr, pAddrLen ); Parameter Parameter Socket pRecv Length Flags pAddr pAddrLen Description [IN] A socket descriptor of a socket. [OUT] A pointer to a buffer for incoming data. [IN] Specifies the size of the buffer pRecv in bytes. [IN] OR-combination of one or more of the values listed in the table below. [OUT] An optional pointer to a buffer where the address of the connecting entity is stored. The format of the address depends on the defined address family which was defined when the socket was created. [IN/OUT] An optional pointer to an integer where the length of the received address is stored. Just like the format of the address, the length of the address depends on the defined address family. Table 5.13: recvfrom() parameter list Valid values for parameter Flags Value MSG_PEEK Description "Peek" at the data present on the socket; the data are returned, but not consumed, so that a subsequent receive operation will see the same data. Return value The number of bytes received or -1 if an error occurred. Additional information If pAddr is not a NULL pointer, the source address of the message is filled in. pAddrLen is a value-result parameter, initialized to the size of the buffer associated with pAddr, and modified on return to indicate the actual size of the address stored there. If a message is too long to fit in the supplied buffer, excess bytes may be discarded depending on the type of socket the message is received from. Refer to socket() on page 167 for more information about the different types of sockets. If no messages are available at the socket and the socket is blocking, the receive call waits for a message to arrive. If the socket is non-blocking (refer to setsockopt() on page 164 for more information), -1 is returned. You can use the select() function to determine when more data arrives. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 159 5.1.12 select() Description Examines the socket descriptor sets whose addresses are passed in readfds, writefds, and exceptfds to see if some of their descriptors are ready for reading, ready for writing or have an exception condition pending. Prototype int select ( IP_FD_set * readfds, IP_FD_set * writefds, IP_FD_set * exceptfds; long tv ); Parameter Parameter readfds writefds exceptfds tv Description See below. Table 5.14: select() parameter list Return value Returns a non-negative value on success. A positive value indicates the number of ready descriptors in the descriptor sets. 0 indicates that the time limit specified by tv expired. On failure, select() returns -1 and the descriptor sets are not changed. Additional information On return, select() replaces the given descriptor sets with subsets consisting of those descriptors that are ready for the requested operation. The total number of ready descriptors in all the sets is returned. Any of readfds, writefds, and exceptfds may be given as NULL pointers if no descriptors are of interest. Selecting true for reading on a socket descriptor upon which a listen() call has been performed indicates that a subsequent accept() call on that descriptor will not block. In the standard Berkeley UNIX Sockets API, the descriptor sets are stored as bit fields in arrays of integers. This works in the UNIX environment because under UNIX socket descriptors are file system descriptors which are guaranteed to be small integers that can be used as indexes into the bit fields. In embOS/IP, socket descriptors are pointers and thus a bit field representation of the descriptor sets is not feasible. Because of this, the embOS/IP API differs from the Berkeley standard in that the descriptor sets are represented as instances of the following structure: typedef struct IP_FD_SET { unsigned fd_count; long fd_array[FD_SETSIZE]; } IP_fd_set; // The select socket array manager // how many are SET? // an array of SOCKETs Instead of a socket descriptor being represented in a descriptor set via an indexed bit, an embOS/IP socket descriptor is represented in a descriptor set by its presence in the fd_array field of the associated IP_FD_SET structure. Despite this non-standard representation of the descriptor sets themselves, the following standard entry points are provided for manipulating such descriptor sets: IP_FD_ZERO (&fdset) initializes a descriptor set fdset to the null set. IP_FD_SET(fd, &fdset) includes a particular descriptor, fd, in fdset. IP_FD_CLR(fd, &fdset) removes fd from fdset. IP_FD_ISSET(fd, &fdset) is nonzero if fd is a member of fdset, zero otherwise. These entry points behave according to the standard Berkeley semantics. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 160 CHAPTER 5 Socket interface You should be aware that the value of FD_SETSIZE defines the maximum number of descriptors that can be represented in a single descriptor set. The default value of FD_SETSIZE is 12. This value can be increased in the source code version of embOS/ IP to accommodate a larger maximum number of descriptors at the cost of increased processor stack usage. Another difference between the Berkeley and embOS/IP select() calls is the representation of the timeout parameter. Under Berkeley Sockets, the timeout parameter is represented by a pointer to a structure. Under embOS/IP sockets, a timeout is specified by the tv parameter, which defines the maximum number of seconds that should elapse before the call to select() returns. A tv parameter equal to 0 implies that select() should return immediately (effectively a poll of the sockets in the descriptor sets). A tv parameter equal to -1 implies that select() blocks forever unless one of its descriptors becomes ready. The final difference between the Berkeley and embOS/IP versions of select() is the absence in the embOS/IP version of the Berkeley width parameter. The width parameter is of use only when descriptor sets are represented as bit arrays and was thus deleted in the embOS/IP implementation. Note: Under rare circumstances, select() may indicate that a descriptor is ready for writing when in fact an attempt to write would block. This can happen if system resources necessary for a write are exhausted or otherwise unavailable. If an application deems it critical that writes to a file descriptor not block, it should set the descriptor for non-blocking I/O. Refer to setsockopt() on page 164 for detailed information. Example static void _Client() { long Socket; struct sockaddr_in Addr; IP_fd_set readfds; char RecvBuffer[1472] int r; while (IP_IFaceIsReady() == 0) { OS_Delay(100); } Restart: Socket = socket(AF_INET, SOCK_DGRAM, 0); // Open socket Addr.sin_family = AF_INET; Addr.sin_port = htons(2222); Addr.sin_addr.s_addr = INADDR_ANY; r = bind(Socket, (struct sockaddr *)&Addr, sizeof(Addr)); if (r == -1){ socketclose(Socket); OS_Delay(1000); goto Restart; } while(1) { IP_FD_ZERO(&readfds); // Clear the set IP_FD_SET(Socket, &readfds); // Add descriptor to the set r = select(&readfds, NULL, NULL, 5000); // Check for activity. if (r <= 0) { continue; // No socket activity or error detected } if (IP_FD_ISSET(Socket, &readfds)) { IP_FD_CLR(Socket, &readfds); // Remove socket from set r = recvfrom(Socket, RecvBuffer, sizeof(RecvBuffer), 0, NULL, NULL); if (r == -1){ socketclose(Socket) goto Restart; } } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 161 OS_Delay(100); } } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 162 CHAPTER 5 Socket interface 5.1.13 send() Description Sends data to a connected socket. Prototype int send ( long Socket, char * pSend, int Length, int Flags ); Parameter Parameter Socket pSend Length Flags Description [IN] A descriptor identifying a socket. [IN] A pointer to a buffer of data which should be sent. [IN] The length of the message which should be sent. [IN] OR-combination of one or more of the valid values listed in the table below. Table 5.15: send() parameter list Valid values for parameter Flags Value MSG_DONTROUTE Description Specifies that the data should not be subject to routing. Return value The total number of bytes which were sent or -1 if an error occurred. Additional information send() may be used only when the socket is in a connected state. Refer to sendto() on page 163 for information about sending data to a non-connected socket. If no messages space is available at the socket to hold the message to be transmitted, then send() normally blocks, unless the socket has been placed in non-blocking I/O mode. MSG_DONTROUTE is usually used only by diagnostic or routing programs. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 163 5.1.14 sendto() Description Sends data to a specified address. Prototype int sendto ( long Socket, char * pSend, int Length, int Flags, struct sockaddr * pAddr, int ToLen ); Parameter Parameter Socket pSend Length Flags pAddr ToLen Description [IN] A descriptor identifying a socket. [IN] A pointer to a buffer of data which should be sent. [IN] The length of the message which should be sent. [IN] OR-combination of one or more of the valid values listed in the table below. [IN] An optional pointer to a buffer where the address of the connected entity is stored. The format of the address depends on the defined address family which was defined when the socket was created. [IN] The size of the address in pAddr. Table 5.16: sendto() parameter list Valid values for parameter Flags Value MSG_DONTROUTE Description Specifies that the data should not be subject to routing. Return value The total number of bytes which were sent or -1 if an error occurred. Additional information In contrast to send(), sendto() can be used at any time. The connection state is in which case the address of the target is given by the pAddr parameter. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 164 CHAPTER 5 Socket interface 5.1.15 setsockopt() Description Sets a socket option. Prototype int setsockopt ( long Socket, int Level, int Option, void * pData, int DataLen ); Parameter Parameter Socket Level Option pData DataLen Description [IN] A descriptor identifying a socket. [IN] Compatibility parameter for setsockopt() and getsockopt(). Use symbol SOL_SOCKET. [IN] The socket option for which the value is to be set. [IN] A pointer to the buffer in which the value for the requested option is supplied. [IN] The size of the pData buffer. Table 5.17: setsocketopt() parameter list Valid values for parameter Option Value Description Standard option flags. SO_DONTROUTE SO_KEEPALIVE SO_LINGER SO_TIMESTAMP Outgoing messages should bypass the standard routing facilities. Instead, messages are directed to the appropriate network interface according to the network portion of the destination address. By default, this socket option is disabled. Enable periodic transmission of messages on a connected socket. If the connected party fails to respond to these messages, the connection is considered broken. By default, this socket option is enabled. Controls the action taken when unsent messages are queued on a socket and a closesocket() is performed. Refer to closesocket() on page 145 for detailed information about the linger option. By default, this socket option is disabled. Enable the TCP timestamp option. By default, this socket option is disabled. embOS/IP socket options. SO_CALLBACK SO_RCVTIMEO UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP Sets zero-copy callback routine. Refer to TCP zero-copy interface on page 175 for detailed information. Sets a timeout for recv(). This changes the behavior of recv(). recv() is by default a blocking function which only returns if data has been received. If a timeout is set recv() will return in case of data reception or timeout. By default, this socket option is disabled. (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 165 Value SO_NONBLOCK IP_HDRINCL Description Sets socket blocking status. Allows the caller to specify blocking or non-blocking IO that works the same as the other Boolean socket options. pData points to an integer value which will contain a non-zero value to set non-blocking IO or a 0 value to reset non-blocking IO. By default, this socket option is disabled. Configures if the IP header has to be included by the user or if the IP header is generated by the stack. Return value 0 on success Example void _EnableKeepAlive(long sock) { int v = 1; setsockopt(sock, SOL_SOCKET, SO_KEEPALIVE, &v, sizeof(v)); } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 166 CHAPTER 5 Socket interface 5.1.16 shutdown() Description Disables sends or receives on a socket. Prototype int shutdown( long Socket, int Mode ); Parameter Parameter Socket Mode Description [IN] A descriptor identifying a socket. [IN] Indicator which part of communication should be disabled. Refer to additional information below. Table 5.18: shutdown() parameter list Return value Returns 0 on success. On failure, it returns -1. Additional information A shutdown() call causes all or part of a full-duplex connection on the socket associated with Socket to be shut down. If Mode is 0, then further receives will be disallowed. If Mode is 1, then further sends will be disallowed. If Mode is 2, then further sends and receives will be disallowed. The shutdown function does not block regardless of the SO_LINGER setting on the socket. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 167 5.1.17 socket() Description Creates a socket. A socket is an endpoint for communication. Prototype long socket ( int Domain, int Type, int Proto ); Parameter Parameter Domain Type Proto Description [IN] Protocol family which should be used. [IN] Specifies the type of the socket. [IN] Specifies the protocol which should be used with the socket. Must be set to zero except when Type is SOCK_RAW. Table 5.19: socket() parameter list Valid values for parameter Domain Value AF_INET Description IPv4 - Internet protocol version 4 Valid values for parameter Type Value SOCK_STREAM SOCK_DGRAM SOCK_RAW Description Stream socket Datagram socket RAW socket Return value A non-negative descriptor on success. On failure, it returns -1. Additional information The Domain parameter specifies a communication domain within which communication will take place; the communication domain selects the protocol family which should be used. The protocol family generally is the same as the address family for the addresses supplied in later operations on the socket. A SOCK_STREAM socket provides sequenced, reliable, two-way connection based byte streams. A SOCK_DGRAM socket supports datagrams (connectionless, unreliable messages of a fixed - typically small - maximum length). Sockets of type SOCK_STREAM are full-duplex byte streams, similar to UNIX pipes. A stream socket must be in a connected state before it can send or receive data. A connection to another socket is created with a connect() call. Once connected, data can be transferred using send() and recv() calls. When a session has been completed, a closesocket() should be performed. The communications protocols used to implement a SOCK_STREAM ensure that data is not lost or duplicated. If a piece of data (for which the peer protocol has buffer space) cannot be successfully transmitted within a reasonable length of time, then the connection is considered broken and calls will return -1 which indicates an error. The protocols optionally keep sockets "warm" by forcing transmissions roughly every UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 168 CHAPTER 5 Socket interface minute in the absence of other activity. An error is then indicated if no response can be elicited on an otherwise idle connection for a extended period (such as five minutes). SOCK_DGRAM sockets allow sending of datagrams to correspondents named in sendto() calls. Datagrams are generally received with recvfrom(), which returns the next datagram with its return address. SOCK_RAW sockets allow receiving data including network and IP header and allow sending of data either with or without specifying the IP header yourself. RAW sockets are operated the same way as SOCK_DGRAM sockets but allow the ability to receive data including the IP and protocol header and to implement your own protocol. For using RAW sockets it is mandatory to call IP_RAW_Add() on page 77 during the initialization of the stack. More information about RAW sockets can be found below. The operation of sockets is controlled by socket-level options. The getsockopt() and setsockopt() functions are used to get and set options. Refer to getsockopt() on page 152 and setsockopt() on page 164 for detailed information. RAW sockets (receiving) For RAW sockets the Proto parameter specifies the IP protocol that will be received using this socket. Protocols registered to be used with IP_*_Add() will be handled the stack and can not be used with RAW sockets at the same time. Using IPPROTO_RAW will receive data for any protocol not handled by the IP stack. RAW sockets (sending) For RAW sockets the Proto parameter specifies the IP protocol that will be entered into the IP header when sending data using this socket. Using IPPROTO_RAW for Proto for a sending socket results in the same as setting the socket option IP_HDRINCL for this socket by using setsockopt() on page 164 and requires the user to include his own IP header in the data to send. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 169 5.2 Socket data structures 5.2.1 Structure sockaddr Description This structure holds socket address information for many types of sockets. Prototype struct sockaddr { U16 sa_family; char sa_data[14]; }; Member sa_family sa_data Description Address family. Normally AF_INET. The character array sa_data contains the destination address and port number for the socket. Table 5.20: Structure sockaddr member list Additional information The structure sockaddr is mostly used as function parameter. To deal with struct sockaddr, a parallel structure struct sockaddr_in is implemented. The structure sockaddr_in is the same size as structure sockaddr, so that a pointer can freely be casted from one type to the other. Refer to Structure sockaddr_in on page 170 for more information and an example. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 170 CHAPTER 5 5.2.2 Socket interface Structure sockaddr_in Description Structure for handling internet addresses. Prototype struct sockaddr_in { short sin_family; unsigned short sin_port; struct in_addr sin_addr; char sin_zero[8]; }; Member sin_family sin_port sin_addr sin_zero Description Address family. Normally AF_INET. Port number for the socket. Structure of type in_addr. The structure represents a 4-byte number that represents one digit in an IP address per byte. sin_zero member is unused. Table 5.21: Structure sockaddr_in member list Example Refer to connect() on page 146 for an example. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 171 5.2.3 Structure in_addr Description 4-byte number that represents one digit in an IP address per byte. Prototype struct in_addr { unsigned long s_addr; }; Member s_addr Description Number that represents one digit in an IP address per byte. Table 5.22: Structure in_addr member list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 172 CHAPTER 5 5.2.4 Socket interface Structure hostent Description The hostent structure is used by functions to store information about a given host, such as host name, IPv4 address, and so on. Prototype struct hostent { char * h_name; char ** h_aliases; int h_addrtype; int h_length; char ** h_addr_list; }; Member h_name h_aliases s_addrtype h_length s_addr_list Description Official name of the host. Alias list. Host address type. Length of the address. List of addresses from the name server. Table 5.23: Structure in_addr member list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 173 5.3 Error codes The following table contains a list of generic error codes, generally full success is 0. Definite errors are negative numbers, and indeterminate conditions are positive numbers. Symbolic name IP_ERR_PARAM IP_ERR_LOGIC IP_ERR_NOMEM IP_ERR_NOBUFFER IP_ERR_RESOURCE IP_ERR_BAD_STATE IP_ERR_TIMEOUT IP_ERR_BAD_HEADER IP_ERR_NO_ROUTE IP_ERR_SEND_PENDING IP_ERR_NOT_MINE Value Description Programming errors -10 Bad parameter. Sequence of events that shouldn't hap-11 pen. System errors -20 malloc() or calloc() failed. -21 Run out of free packets. -22 Run out of other queue-able resource. -23 TCP layer error. -24 Timeout error on TCP layer. Networking errors -32 Bad header at upper layer (for upcalls). -33 Can not find a reasonable next IP hop. Networking errors 1 Packet queued pending an ARP reply. 2 Packet was not of interest (upcall reply). Table 5.24: embOS/IP error types UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 174 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP CHAPTER 5 Socket interface (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 175 Chapter 6 TCP zero-copy interface The TCP protocol can be used via socket functions or the TCP zero-copy interface which is described in this chapter. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 176 CHAPTER 6 6.1 TCP zero-copy interface TCP zero-copy This section documents an optional extension to the Sockets layer, the TCP zero-copy API. The TCP zero-copy API is intended to assist the development of higher-performance embedded network applications by allowing the application direct access to the TCP/IP stack packet buffers. This feature can be used to avoid the overhead of having the stack copy data between application-owned buffers and stack-owned buffers in send() and recv(), but the application has to fit its data into, and accept its data from, the stack buffers. The TCP zero-copy API is small because it is simply an extension to the existing Sockets API that provides an alternate mechanism for sending and receiving data on a socket. The Sockets API is used for all other operations on the socket. 6.1.1 Allocating, freeing and sending packet buffers The two functions for allocating and freeing packet buffers are straightforward requests: IP_TCP_Alloc() allocates a packet buffer from the pool of packet buffers on the stack and IP_TCP_Free() frees a packet buffer. Applications using the TCP zero-copy API are responsible for allocating packet buffers for use in sending data, as well as for freeing buffers that have been used to receive data and those that the application has allocated but decided not to use for sending data. As these packet buffers are a limited resource, it is important that applications free them promptly when they are no longer of use. The functions for sending data, IP_TCP_Send() and IP_TCP_SendAndFree(), send a packet buffer of data using a socket. The TCP zero-copy interface supports two different approaches to send and free a packet. One approach is that the stack frees the packet independent from the success of sending the packet. Therefor, IP_TCP_SendAndFree() is called to send and free the packet. It frees the packet independent from the success of the send operation. The other approach is that IP_TCP_Send() is called. In this case it is the responsibility of the application to free the packet. Depending on the return value the application can decide if IP_TCP_Free() should be called to free the packet. 6.1.2 Callback function Applications that use the TCP Zero-copy API for receiving data must include a callback function for acceptance of received packets, and must register the callback function with the socket using the setsockopt() sockets function with the SO_CALLBACK option name. The callback function, once registered, receives not only received data packets, but also connection events that result in socket errors. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 177 6.2 Sending data with the TCP zero-copy API To send data with the TCP zero-copy API, you should proceed as follow: 1. 2. 3. Allocating a packet buffer Filling the allocated buffer Sending the packet The following section describes the procedure for allocating a packet buffer, sending data, and freeing the packet buffer step by step. 6.2.1 Allocating a packet buffer The first step in using the TCP zero-copy API to send data is to allocate a packet buffer from the stack using the IP_TCP_Alloc() function. This function takes the maximum length of the data you intend to send in the buffer as argument and returns a pointer to an IP_PACKET structure. IP_PACKET * pPacket; U32 DataLen; // Amount of data to send DataLen = 512; // Should indicate amount of data to send pPacket = IP_TCP_Alloc(DataLen); if (pPacket == NULL) { // Error, could not allocate packet buffer } This limits how much data you can send in one call using the TCP zero-copy API, as the data sent in one call to IP_TCP_Send() must fit in a single packet buffer. The actual limit is determined by the big packet buffer size, less 68 bytes for protocol headers. If you try to request a larger buffer than this, IP_TCP_Alloc() returns NULL to indicate that it cannot allocate a sufficiently large buffer. 6.2.2 Filling the allocated buffer with data Having allocated the packet buffer, you now fill it with the data to send. The function IP_TCP_Alloc() has initialized the returned IP_PACKET pPacket and so pPacket>pData points to where you can start depositing data. 6.2.3 Sending the packet Finally, you send the packet by giving it back to the stack using the function IP_TCP_Send(). e = IP_TCP_Send(socket, pPacket); if (e < 0) { IP_TCP_Free(pPacket); } This function sends the packet over TCP, or returns an error. If its return value is less than zero, it has not accepted the packet and the application has to decide either to free the packet or to retain it for sending later. Use IP_TCP_SendAndFree() if the packet should be freed automatically in any case. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 178 CHAPTER 6 6.3 TCP zero-copy interface Receiving data with the TCP zero-copy API To receive data with the TCP zero-copy API, you should proceed as follow: 1. 2. 6.3.1 Writing a callback function Registering the callback function Writing a callback function Using the TCP zero-copy API for receiving data requires the application developer to write a callback function that the stack can use to inform the application of received data packets and other socket events. This function is expected to conform to the following prototype: int rx_callback(long Socket, IP_PACKET * pPacket, int code); The stack calls this function when it has received a data packet or other event to report for a socket. The parameter Socket identifies the socket. The parameter pPacket passes a pointer to the packet buffer (if there is a packet buffer). If pPacket is not NULL, it is a pointer to a packet buffer containing received data for the socket. pPacket->pData points to the start of the received data, and pPacket->NumBytes indicates the number of bytes of received data in this buffer. The parameter code passes an error event (if there is an error to report). If code is not 0, it is a socket error indicating that an error or other event has occurred on the socket. Typical nonzero values are ESHUTDOWN and ECONNRESET. ESHUTDOWN defines that the connected peer has closed its end of the connection and sends no more data. ECONNRESET defines that the connected peer has abruptly closed its end of the connection and neither sends nor receives more data. Returned values The callback function may return one of the following values: Symbolic Nume rical IP_OK 0 IP_OK_KEEP_PACKET 1 Description Data handled, packet can be freed. Data will be handled by application later, the stack should NOT free the packet. This will be done by the application at a later time when the data has been handled and the packet is no longer needed. Table 6.1: embOS/IP TCP zero-copy - Valid return values for the receive callback function Note: The callback function is called from the stack and is expected to return promptly. Some of the places where the stack calls the callback function require that the data structures on the stack remain consistent through the callback, so the callback function must not call back into the stack except to call IP_TCP_Free(). 6.3.2 Registering the callback function The application must also inform the stack of the callback function. setsockopt() function provides an additional socket option, SO_CALLBACK, which should be used for this purpose once the socket has been created. The following code fragment illustrates the use of this option to register a callback function named RxUpcall() on the socket Socket: setsockopt(Socket, SOL_SOCKET, SO_CALLBACK, (void *)RxUpcall, 0); The function setsockopt() is described in setsockopt() on page 164. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 179 6.4 API functions Function IP_TCP_Alloc() IP_TCP_Free() IP_TCP_Send() IP_TCP_SendAndFree() Description Allocates a packet buffer. Frees a packet buffer. Sends a packet. Sends and frees a packet. Table 6.2: embOS/IP TCP zero-copy API function overview UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 180 CHAPTER 6 6.4.1 TCP zero-copy interface IP_TCP_Alloc() Description Allocates a packet buffer large enough to hold datasize bytes of TCP data, plus TCP, IP and MAC headers. Prototype IP_PACKET * IP_TCP_Alloc (int datasize); Parameter Parameter datasize Description [IN] Length of the data which should be sent. Table 6.3: IP_TCP_Alloc() parameter list Return value Success: Returns a pointer to the allocated buffer. Error: NULL Additional information This function must be called to allocate a buffer for sending data via IP_TCP_Send(). It returns the allocated packet buffer with its pPacket->pData field set to where the application must deposit the data to be sent. This datasize limits how much data that you can send in one call using the TCP zerocopy API, as the data sent in one call to IP_TCP_Send() must fit in a single packet buffer, with the TCP, IP, and lower-layer headers that the stack needs to add in order to send the packet. The actual limit is determined by the big packet buffer size (normally 1536 bytes). Refer to IP_AddBuffers() on page 48 for more information about defining buffer sizes. If you try to request a larger buffer than this, IP_TCP_Alloc() returns NULL to indicate that it cannot allocate a sufficiently-large buffer. Example IP_PACKET * pPacket; U32 DataLen; // Amount of data to send DataLen = 1024; // Should indicate amount of data to send pPacket = IP_TCP_Alloc(DataLen); if (pPacket == NULL) { // Error, could not allocate packet buffer } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 181 6.4.2 IP_TCP_Free() Description Frees a packet buffer allocated by IP_TCP_Alloc(). Prototype void IP_TCP_Free ( IP_PACKET * pPacket ); Parameter Parameter pPacket Description [IN] Pointer to the IP_Packet structure. Table 6.4: IP_TCP_Free() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 182 CHAPTER 6 6.4.3 TCP zero-copy interface IP_TCP_Send() Description Sends a packet buffer on a socket. Prototype int IP_TCP_Send ( U32 s, IP_PACKET * pPacket ); Parameter Parameter s pPacket Description [IN] Socket descriptor. [IN] Pointer to a packet buffer. Table 6.5: IP_TCP_Send() parameter list Return value 0 The packet was sent successfully. <0 The packet was not accepted by the stack. The application must re-send the packet using a call to IP_TCP_Send(), or free the packet using IP_TCP_Free(). >0 The packet has been accepted and queued on the socket but has not yet been transmitted. Additional information Applications using the TCP zero-copy API are responsible for allocating packet buffers for use in sending data, as well as for freeing buffers that have been used to receive data and those that the application has allocated but decided not to use for sending data. As these packet buffers are a limited resource, it is important that applications free them promptly when they are no longer of use. Packets have to be freed after processing. The TCP zero-copy interface supports two different approaches to free a packet. One approach is that the stack frees the packet independent from the success of sending the packet. Therefor, IP_TCP_SendAndFree() is called to send the packet and free the packet. It frees the packet independent from the success of the send operation. The other approach is that IP_TCP_Send() is called. In this case it is the responsibility application programmer to free the packet. Depending on the return value the application programmer can decide if IP_TCP_Free() should be called to free the packet. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 183 6.4.4 IP_TCP_SendAndFree() Description Sends a packet buffer on a socket. Prototype int IP_TCP_SendAndFree ( U32 s, IP_PACKET * pPacket ); Parameter Parameter s pPacket Description [IN] Socket descriptor. [IN] Pointer to the IP_Packet structure. Table 6.6: IP_TCP_Send() parameter list Return value 0 The packet was sent successfully. <0 The packet was not accepted by the stack. >0 The packet has been accepted and queued on the socket but has not yet been transmitted. Additional information Applications using the TCP zero-copy API are responsible for allocating packet buffers for use in sending data, as well as for freeing buffers that have been used to receive data and those that the application has allocated but decided not to use for sending data. As these packet buffers are a limited resource, it is important that applications free them promptly when they are no longer of use. IP_TCP_SendAndFree() frees packet pPacket after processing. It frees the packet independent from the success of the send operation. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 184 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP CHAPTER 6 TCP zero-copy interface (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 185 Chapter 7 UDP zero-copy interface The UDP transfer protocol can be used via socket functions or the zero-copy interface which is described in this chapter. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 186 CHAPTER 7 7.1 UDP zero-copy interface UDP zero-copy The UDP zero-copy API functions are provided for systems that do not need the overhead of sockets. These routines impose a lower demand on CPU and system memory requirements than sockets. However, they do not offer the portability of sockets. UDP zero-copy API functions are intended to assist the development of higher-performance embedded network applications by allowing the application direct access to the UDP/IP stack packet buffers. This feature can be used to avoid the overhead of having the stack copy data between application-owned buffers and stack-owned buffers in sendto() and recvfrom(), but the application has to fit its data into, and accept its data from the stack buffers. Refer to embOS/IP UDP discover (OS_IP_UDPDiscover.c / OS_IP_UDPDiscoverZeroCopy.c) on page 41 for detailed dinformation about the UDP zero-copy example application. 7.1.1 Allocating, freeing and sending packet buffers The two functions for allocating and freeing packet buffers are straightforward requests: IP_UDP_Alloc() allocates a packet buffer from the pool of packet buffers on the stack and IP_UDP_Free() frees a packet buffer. Applications using the UDP zero-copy API are responsible for allocating packet buffers for use in sending data, as well as for freeing buffers that have been used to receive data and those that the application has allocated but decided not to use for sending data. As these packet buffers are a limited resource, it is important that applications free them promptly when they are no longer of use. The functions for sending data, IP_UDP_Send() and IP_UDP_SendAndFree(), send a packet buffer of data using a port. The UDP zero-copy interface supports two different approaches to send and free a packet. One approach is that the stack frees the packet independent from the success of sending the packet. Therefor, IP_UDP_SendAndFree() is called to send and free the packet. It frees the packet independent from the success of the send operation. The other approach is that IP_UDP_Send() is called. In this case it is the responsibility of the application to free the packet. Depending on the return value the application can decide if IP_UDP_Free() should be called to free the packet. 7.1.2 Callback function Applications that use the UDP zero-copy API for receiving data must include a callback function for acceptance of received packets, and must register the callback function with a port using the IP_UDP_Open() function. The callback function, once registered, receives all matching data packets. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 187 7.2 Sending data with the UDP zero-copy API To send data with the UDP zero-copy API, you should proceed as follow: 1. 2. 3. Allocating a packet buffer Filling the allocated buffer Sending the packet The following section describes the procedure for allocating a packet buffer, sending data, and freeing the packet buffer step by step. 7.2.1 Allocating a packet buffer The first step in using the UDP zero-copy API to send data is to allocate a packet buffer from the stack using the IP_UDP_Alloc() function. This function takes the maximum length of the data you intend to send in the buffer as argument and returns a pointer to an IP_PACKET structure. IP_PACKET * pPacket; U32 DataLen; // Amount of data to send DataLen = 512; // Should indicate amount of data to send pPacket = IP_UDP_Alloc(DataLen); if (pPacket == NULL) { // Error, could not allocate packet buffer } This limits how much data you can send in one call using the UDP zero-copy API, as the data sent in one call to IP_UDP_Send() must fit in a single packet buffer. The actual limit is determined by the big packet buffer size, less typically 42 bytes for protocol headers (14 bytes for Ethernet header, 20 bytes IP header, 8 bytes UDP header). If you try to request a larger buffer than this, IP_UDP_Alloc() returns NULL to indicate that it cannot allocate a sufficiently large buffer. 7.2.2 Filling the allocated buffer with data Having allocated the packet buffer, you now fill it with the data to send. The function IP_UDP_Alloc() has initialized the returned IP_PACKET pPacket and so pPacket>pData points to where you can start depositing data. 7.2.3 Sending the packet Finally, you send the packet by giving it back to the stack using the function IP_UDP_Send(). #define SRC_PORT 50020 #define DEST_PORT 50020 #define DEST_ADDR 0xC0A80101 e = IP_UDP_Send(0, DEST_ADDR, SRC_PORT, DEST_PORT, pPacket); if (e < 0) { IP_UDP_Free(pPacket); } This function sends the packet over UDP, or returns an error. If its return value is less than zero, it has not accepted the packet and the application has to decide either to free the packet or to retain it for sending later. Use IP_UDP_SendAndFree() if the packet should be freed automatically in any case. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 188 CHAPTER 7 7.3 UDP zero-copy interface Receiving data with the UDP zero-copy API To receive data with the UDP zero-copy API, you should proceed as follow: 1. 2. 7.3.1 Writing a callback function Registering the callback function Writing a callback function Using the UDP zero-copy API for receiving data requires the application developer to write a callback function that the stack can use to inform the application of received data packets. This function is expected to conform to the following prototype: int rx_callback(IP_PACKET * pPacket, void * pContext) The stack calls this function when it has received a data packet for a port. The parameter pPacket points to the packet buffer. The packet buffer contains the received data for the socket. pPacket->pData points to the start of the received data, and pPacket->NumBytes indicates the number of bytes of received data in this buffer. Returned values The callback function may return one of the following values: Symbolic Nume rical IP_OK 0 IP_OK_KEEP_PACKET 1 Description Data handled. embOS/IP will free the packet. Data will be handled by application later, the stack should NOT free the packet. This will be done by the application at a later time when the data has been handled and the packet is no longer needed. Table 7.1: embOS/IP UDP zero-copy - Valid return values for the receive callback function Note: The callback function is called from the stack and is expected to return promptly. Some of the places where the stack calls the callback function require that the data structures on the stack remain consistent through the callback, so the callback function must not call back into the stack except to call IP_UDP_Free(). 7.3.2 Registering the callback function The application must also inform the stack of the callback function. This is done by calling the IP_UDP_Open() function. The following code fragment illustrates the use of this option to register a callback function named RxUpcall() on the port 50020: #define SRC_PORT 50020 #define DEST_PORT 50020 IP_UDP_Open(0L /* any foreign host */, SRC_PORT, DEST_PORT, RxUpCall, 0L /* any tag */); The function IP_UDP_Open() is described in IP_UDP_Open() on page 201. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 189 7.4 API functions Function IP_UDP_Alloc() IP_UDP_Close() IP_UDP_FindFreePort() IP_UDP_Free() IP_UDP_GetDataSize() IP_UDP_GetDataPtr() IP_UDP_GetDestAddr() IP_UDP_GetFPort() IP_UDP_GetIFIndex() IP_UDP_GetLPort() IP_UDP_GetSrcAddr() IP_UDP_Open() IP_UDP_OpenEx() IP_UDP_Send() IP_UDP_SendAndFree() Description Returns a pointer to a packet buffer big enough for the specified sizes. Closes a UDP connection handle. Returns a free local port number. Frees the buffer which was used for a packet. Returns size of data contained in the received UDP packet. Returns pointer to data contained in the received UDP packet. Retrieves the IP address of the destination of the given UDP packet. Extracts foreign port information from a UDP packet. Extract the interface on which the packet has been received. Extracts local port information from a UDP packet. Retrieves the IP address of the sender of the given UDP packet. Creates a UDP connection handle. Creates a UDP connection handle. Sends an UDP packet to a specified host. Sends an UDP packet to a specified host and frees the packet. Table 7.2: embOS/IP UDP zero-copy API function overview UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 190 CHAPTER 7 7.4.1 UDP zero-copy interface IP_UDP_Alloc() Description Returns a pointer to a packet buffer big enough for the specified sizes. Prototype IP_PACKET * IP_UDP_Alloc( int NumBytes ); Parameter Parameter NumBytes Description [IN] Length of the data which should be sent. Table 7.3: IP_UDP_Alloc() parameter list Return value Success: Returns a pointer to the allocated buffer. Error: NULL Additional information Applications using the UDP zero-copy API are responsible for allocating packet buffers for use in sending data, as well as for freeing buffers that have been used to receive data and those that the application has allocated but decided not to use for sending data. As these packet buffers are a limited resource, it is important that applications free them promptly when they are no longer of use. The UDP zero-copy interface supports two different approaches to free a packet. One approach is that the stack frees the packet independent from the success of sending the packet. Therefor, IP_UDP_SendAndFree() is called to send the packet and free the packet. It frees the packet independent from the success of the send operation. The other approach is that IP_UDP_Send() is called. In this case it is the responsibility application programmer to free the packet. Depending on the return value the application programmer can decide if IP_UDP_Free() should be called to free the packet. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 191 7.4.2 IP_UDP_Close() Description Closes a UDP connection handle and removes the connection from demux table list of connections and deallocates it. Prototype void IP_UDP_Close( IP_UDP_CONN Con ); Parameter Parameter Con Description [IN] UDP connection handle. Table 7.4: IP_UDP_Close() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 192 CHAPTER 7 7.4.3 UDP zero-copy interface IP_UDP_FindFreePort() Description Obtains a random port number. that is suitable for use as the lport parameter in a call to IP_UDP_Open(). Prototype U16 IP_UDP_FindFreePort( void ); Return value A usable port number in local endianess. Additional information The returned port number is suitable for use as the lport parameter in a call to IP_UDP_Open(). Refer to IP_UDP_Open() on page 201 for more information. IP_UDP_FindFreePort() avoids picking port numbers in the reserved range 0-1024, or in the range 1025-1199, which may be used for server applications. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 193 7.4.4 IP_UDP_Free() Description Frees the buffer which was used for a packet. Prototype void IP_UDP_Free( IP_PACKET * pPacket ); Parameter Parameter pPacket Description [IN] Pointer to a packet structure. Table 7.5: IP_UDP_Free() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 194 CHAPTER 7 7.4.5 UDP zero-copy interface IP_UDP_GetDataSize() Description Returns size of data contained in the received UDP packet. Prototype U16 IP_UDP_GetDataSize( const IP_PACKET *pPacket ); Parameter Parameter pPacket Description [IN] Pointer to a packet structure. Table 7.6: IP_UDP_GetDataSize() parameter list Return value Size of data contained in received UDP packet. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 195 7.4.6 IP_UDP_GetDataPtr() Description Returns pointer to data contained in the received UDP packet. Prototype void * IP_UDP_GetDataPtr( const IP_PACKET * pPacket ); Parameter Parameter pPacket Description [IN] Pointer to a packet structure. Table 7.7: IP_UDP_GetDataPtr() parameter list Return value Pointer to the data part of the UDP packet. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 196 CHAPTER 7 7.4.7 UDP zero-copy interface IP_UDP_GetDestAddr() Description Extracts destination address information from a UDP packet. Prototype void IP_UDP_GetDestAddr( const IP_PACKET * pPacket, void * pDestAddr, int AddrLen ); Parameter Parameter pPacket pDestAddr AddrLen Description [IN] Pointer to a packet structure. [IN] Pointer to a buffer to store the destination address. [IN] Size of the buffer used to store the destination address. Table 7.8: IP_UDP_GetDestAddr() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 197 7.4.8 IP_UDP_GetFPort() Description Extracts foreign port information from a UDP packet. Prototype U16 IP_UDP_GetFPort ( const IP_PACKET * pPacket ); Parameter Parameter pPacket Description [IN] Pointer to a packet structure. Table 7.9: IP_UDP_GetFPort() parameter list Return value Foreign port extracted from the packet. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 198 CHAPTER 7 7.4.9 UDP zero-copy interface IP_UDP_GetIFIndex() Description Extracts the interface information from a UDP packet. Prototype unsigned IP_UDP_GetIFIndex ( const IP_PACKET * pPacket ); Parameter Parameter pPacket Description [IN] Pointer to a packet structure. Table 7.10: IP_UDP_GetIFIndex() parameter list Return value Zero-based interface index on which the packet was received. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 199 7.4.10 IP_UDP_GetLPort() Description Extracts local port information from a UDP packet. Prototype U16 IP_UDP_GetLPort ( const IP_PACKET * pPacket ); Parameter Parameter pPacket Description [IN] Pointer to a packet structure. Table 7.11: IP_UDP_GetLPort() parameter list Return value Local port extracted from the packet. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 200 CHAPTER 7 UDP zero-copy interface 7.4.11 IP_UDP_GetSrcAddr() Description Extracts source address information from a UDP packet. Prototype void IP_UDP_GetSrcAddr( const IP_PACKET * pPacket, void * pSrcAddr, int AddrLen ); Parameter Parameter pPacket pSrcAddr AddrLen Description [IN] Pointer to a packet structure. [IN] Pointer to a buffer to store the source address. [IN] Size of the buffer used to store the source address. Table 7.12: IP_UDP_GetSrcAddr() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 201 7.4.12 IP_UDP_Open() Description Creates a UDP connection handle to receive, and pass upwards UDP packets that match the parameters passed. Prototype IP_UDP_CONN IP_UDP_Open( IP_ADDR U16 U16 int(*routine) void * FAddr, fport, lport, (IP_PACKET *, void * pContext), pContext ); Parameter Parameter FAddr fport lport (*routine) pContext Description [IN] Foreign IP address. [IN] Foreign port. [IN] Local port. [IN] Callback function which is called when a UDP packet is received. [IN/OUT] Application defined context pointer. Table 7.13: IP_UDP_Open() parameter list Return value Success: Returns a pointer to the UDP connection handle. Error: NULL Additional information The parameters FAddr, fport, and lport, can be set to 0 as a wild card, which enables the reception of broadcast datagrams. The callback handler function is called with a pointer to a received datagram and a copy of the data pointer which is passed to IP_UDP_Open(). This can be any data the programmer requires, such as a pointer to another function, or a control structure to aid in demultiplexing the received UDP packet. The returned handle is used as parameter for IP_UDP_Close() IP_UDP_Close() is not called, there is no need to safe the return value. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP only. If (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 202 CHAPTER 7 UDP zero-copy interface 7.4.13 IP_UDP_OpenEx() Description Creates a UDP connection handle to receive, and pass upwards UDP packets that match the parameters passed. Prototype IP_UDP_CONN IP_UDP_OpenEx( IP_ADDR U16 IP_ADDR U16 int(*routine) void * FAddr, fport, LAddr, lport, (IP_PACKET *, void * pContext), pContext ); Parameter Parameter FAddr fport LAddr lport (*routine) pContext Description [IN] Foreign IP address. [IN] Foreign port. [IN] Local IP address. [IN] Local port. [IN] Callback function which is called when a UDP packet is received. [IN/OUT] Application defined context pointer. Table 7.14: IP_UDP_OpenEx() parameter list Return value Success: Returns a pointer to the UDP connection handle. Error: NULL Additional information The parameters FAddr, fport, LAddr and lport, can be set to 0 as a wild card, which enables the reception of broadcast datagrams. The callback handler function is called with a pointer to a received datagram and a copy of the data pointer which is passed to IP_UDP_OpenEx(). This can be any data the programmer requires, such as a pointer to another function, or a control structure to aid in demultiplexing the received UDP packet. The returned handle is used as parameter for IP_UDP_Close() IP_UDP_Close() is not called, there is no need to safe the return value. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP only. If (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 203 7.4.14 IP_UDP_Send() Description Send an UDP packet to a specified host. Prototype int IP_UDP_Send( int IP_ADDR U16 U16 IP_PACKET * IFace, FHost, fport, lport, pPacket ); Parameter Parameter IFace IPAddr fport lport pPacket Description [IN] [IN] [IN] [IN] [IN] Zero-based index of available interfaces. IP address of the target host in network endianess. Foreign port. Local port. Data which should be sent to the target host. Table 7.15: IP_UDP_Send() parameter list Return value On success: 0 On error: Non-zero error code Additional information The packet pPacket has to be allocated by calling IP_UDP_Alloc(). Refer to IP_UDP_Alloc() on page 190 for detailed information. If you expect to get any response to this packet you should have opened a UDP connection prior to calling IP_UDP_Send(). Refer to IP_UDP_Open() on page 201 for more information about creating an UDP connection. IP_UDP_Send() does not free the packet after sending. It is the responsibility of the application programmer to free the packet. Depending on the return value the application programmer can decide if IP_UDP_Free() should be called to free the packet. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 204 CHAPTER 7 UDP zero-copy interface 7.4.15 IP_UDP_SendAndFree() Description Send an UDP packet to a specified host and frees the packet. Prototype int IP_UDP_SendAndFree( int IP_ADDR U16 U16 IP_PACKET * IFace, FHost, fport, lport, pPacket ); Parameter Parameter IFace IPAddr fport lport pPacket Description [IN] [IN] [IN] [IN] [IN] Zero-based index of available interfaces. IP address of the target host in network endianess. Foreign port. Local port. Data which should be sent to the target host. Table 7.16: IP_UDP_SendAndFree() parameter list Return value On success: 0 On error: Non-zero error code Additional information The packet pPacket has to be allocated by calling IP_UDP_Alloc(). Refer to IP_UDP_Alloc() on page 72 for detailed information. If you expect to get any response to this packet you should have opened a UDP connection prior to calling this. Refer to IP_UDP_Open() on page 201 for more information about creating an UDP connection. Packets are freed by calling IP_UDP_Free() is required. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP IP_UDP_SendAndFree(). Therefor, no call of (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 205 Chapter 8 RAW zero-copy interface Transferring RAW data can be used via socket functions or the zero-copy interface which is described in this chapter. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 206 CHAPTER 8 8.1 RAW zero-copy interface RAW zero-copy The RAW zero-copy API functions are provided for systems that do not need the overhead of sockets. These routines impose a lower demand on CPU and system memory requirements than sockets. However, they do not offer the portability of sockets. RAW zero-copy API functions are intended to assist the development of higher-performance embedded network applications by allowing the application direct access to the IP stack packet buffers. This feature can be used to avoid the overhead of having the stack copy data between application-owned buffers and stack-owned buffers in sendto() and recvfrom(), but the application has to fit its data into, and accept its data from the stack buffers. To enable RAW socket support in the IP stack it is madatory to call IP_RAW_Add() on page 77 during initialization of the stack. 8.1.1 Allocating, freeing and sending packet buffers The two functions for allocating and freeing packet buffers are straightforward requests: IP_RAW_Alloc() allocates a packet buffer from the pool of packet buffers on the stack and IP_RAW_Free() frees a packet buffer. Applications using the RAW zerocopy API are responsible for allocating packet buffers for use in sending data, as well as for freeing buffers that have been used to receive data and those that the application has allocated but decided not to use for sending data. As these packet buffers are a limited resource, it is important that applications free them promptly when they are no longer of use. The functions for sending data, IP_RAW_Send() and IP_RAW_SendAndFree(), send a packet buffer of data using a specific protocol or sending pure data which requires the user to include his own IP header. The RAW zero-copy interface supports two different approaches to send and free a packet. One approach is that the stack frees the packet independent from the success of sending the packet. Therefor, IP_RAW_SendAndFree() is called to send and free the packet. It frees the packet independent from the success of the send operation. The other approach is that IP_RAW_Send() is called. In this case it is the responsibility of the application to free the packet. Depending on the return value the application can decide if IP_RAW_Free() should be called to free the packet. 8.1.2 Callback function Applications that use the RAW zero-copy API for receiving data must include a callback function for acceptance of received packets, and must register the callback function with a protocol using the IP_RAW_Open() function. The callback function, once registered, receives all matching data packets. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 207 8.2 Sending data with the RAW zero-copy API To send data with the RAW zero-copy API, you should proceed as follow: 1. 2. 3. Allocating a packet buffer Filling the allocated buffer Sending the packet The following section describes the procedure for allocating a packet buffer, sending data, and freeing the packet buffer step by step. 8.2.1 Allocating a packet buffer The first step in using the RAW zero-copy API to send data is to allocate a packet buffer from the stack using the IP_RAW_Alloc() function. This function takes the maximum length of the data you intend to send in the buffer and if the IP header will be written by the stack or by yourself as arguments and returns a pointer to an IP_PACKET structure. IP_PACKET * pPacket; U32 DataLen; // Amount of data to send DataLen = 512; // Should indicate amount of data to send pPacket = IP_RAW_Alloc(0, DataLen, 0); // Stack will write IP header if (pPacket == NULL) { // Error, could not allocate packet buffer } This limits how much data you can send in one call using the RAW zero-copy API, as the data sent in one call to IP_RAW_Send() must fit in a single packet buffer. The actual limit is determined by the big packet buffer size, less typically 34 bytes for protocol headers (14 bytes for Ethernet header, 20 bytes IP header). If you try to request a larger buffer than this, IP_RAW_Alloc() returns NULL to indicate that it cannot allocate a sufficiently large buffer. If you decide to provide the IP header yourself you can allocate a packet buffer the following way: pPacket = IP_RAW_Alloc(0, DataLen, 1); In this case the packet size allocate limit is determined by the big packet buffer size, less typically 14 bytes for the Ethernet header. 8.2.2 Filling the allocated buffer with data Having allocated the packet buffer, you now fill it with the data to send. The function IP_RAW_Alloc() has initialized the returned IP_PACKET pPacket and so pPacket>pData points to where you can start depositing data. Depending on if you decided to provide your own IP header you will have to store this data starting at pPacket->pData as well. 8.2.3 Sending the packet Finally, you send the packet by giving it back to the stack using the function IP_RAW_Send(). #define PROTOCOL 1 // ICMP #define DEST_ADDR 0xC0A80101 e = IP_RAW_Send(0, DEST_ADDR, PROTOCOL, pPacket); if (e < 0) { IP_RAW_Free(pPacket); } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 208 CHAPTER 8 RAW zero-copy interface This function sends the packet specifying the ICMP protocol in the IP header, or returns an error. If its return value is less than zero, it has not accepted the packet and the application has to decide either to free the packet or to retain it for sending later. Use IP_RAW_SendAndFree() if the packet should be freed automatically in any case. In case you intend to provide your own IP header the protocol passed has to be IPPROTO_RAW . This prevents the stack to generate and include a header on its own. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 209 8.3 Receiving data with the RAW zero-copy API To receive data with the RAW zero-copy API, you should proceed as follow: 1. 2. 8.3.1 Writing a callback function Registering the callback function Writing a callback function Using the RAW zero-copy API for receiving data requires the application developer to write a callback function that the stack can use to inform the application of received data packets. This function is expected to conform to the following prototype: int rx_callback(IP_PACKET * pPacket, void * pContext) The stack calls this function when it has received a data packet for a protocol. The parameter pPacket points to the packet buffer. The packet buffer contains the received data for the socket. pPacket->pData points to the start of the received data (including network and IP header), and pPacket->NumBytes indicates the number of bytes of received data in this buffer. Returned values The callback function may return one of the following values: Nume rical Symbolic IP_OK 0 IP_OK_KEEP_PACKET 1 Description Data handled. embOS/IP will free the packet. Data will be handled by application later, the stack should NOT free the packet. This will be done by the application at a later time when the data has been handled and the packet is no longer needed. Table 8.1: embOS/IP RAW zero-copy - Valid return values for the receive callback function Note: The callback function is called from the stack and is expected to return promptly. Some of the places where the stack calls the callback function require that the data structures on the stack remain consistent through the callback, so the callback function must not call back into the stack except to call IP_RAW_Free(). 8.3.2 Registering the callback function The application must also inform the stack of the callback function. This is done by calling the IP_RAW_Open() function. The following code fragment illustrates the use of this option to register a callback function named RxUpcall() for the ICMP protocol: #define PROTOCOL 1 // ICMP IP_RAW_Open(0L /* any foreign host */, 0L /* any local host */, PROTOCOL, RxUpCall, 0L /* any tag */); The function IP_RAW_Open() is described in IP_RAW_Open() on page 219 . To receive ICMP packets the ICMP protocol has not to be added to the stack by calling IP_ICMP_Add(). Protocols known to the stack and added for handling through the stack can not be used with the RAW zero-copy API. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 210 8.4 CHAPTER 8 RAW zero-copy interface API functions Function IP_RAW_Alloc() IP_RAW_Close() IP_RAW_Free() IP_RAW_GetDataPtr() IP_RAW_GetDataSize() IP_RAW_GetDestAddr() IP_RAW_GetIFIndex() IP_RAW_GetSrcAddr() IP_RAW_Open() IP_RAW_Send() IP_RAW_SendAndFree() Description Returns a pointer to a packet buffer big enough for the specified sizes. Closes a RAW connection handle. Frees the buffer which was used for a packet. Returns pointer to data contained in the received RAW packet. Retrieves the payload size in the packet. Retrieves the IP address of the destination of the given RAW packet. Extract the interface on which the packet has been received. Retrieves the IP address of the sender of the given RAW packet. Creates a RAW connection handle. Sends a RAW packet to a specified host. Sends a RAW packet to a specified host and frees the packet. Table 8.2: embOS/IP RAW zero-copy API function overview UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 211 8.4.1 IP_RAW_Alloc() Description Returns a pointer to a packet buffer big enough for the specified sizes. Prototype IP_PACKET * IP_RAW_Alloc( unsigned IFaceId, int NumBytes, int IpHdrIncl ); Parameter Parameter IFaceId NumBytes IpHdrIncl Description [IN] Zero-based index of available interfaces. [IN] Length of the data which should be sent. [IN] Specifies if the IP header is generated or has to be provided by the user. 0: Header generated by the stack; 1: Header to be provided in the packet data by the user. Table 8.3: IP_RAW_Alloc() parameter list Return value Success: Returns a pointer to the allocated buffer. Error: NULL Additional information Applications using the RAW zero-copy API are responsible for allocating packet buffers for use in sending data, as well as for freeing buffers that have been used to receive data and those that the application has allocated but decided not to use for sending data. As these packet buffers are a limited resource, it is important that applications free them promptly when they are no longer of use. The RAW zero-copy interface supports two different approaches to free a packet. One approach is that the stack frees the packet independent from the success of sending the packet. Therefor, IP_RAW_SendAndFree() is called to send the packet and free the packet. It frees the packet independent from the success of the send operation. The other approach is that IP_RAW_Send() is called. In this case it is the responsibility application programmer to free the packet. Depending on the return value the application programmer can decide if IP_RAW_Free() should be called to free the packet. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 212 CHAPTER 8 8.4.2 RAW zero-copy interface IP_RAW_Close() Description Closes a RAW connection handle and removes the connection from demux table list of connections and deallocates it. Prototype void IP_RAW_Close( IP_RAW_CONN Con ); Parameter Parameter Con Description [IN] RAW connection handle. Table 8.4: IP_RAW_Close() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 213 8.4.3 IP_RAW_Free() Description Frees the buffer which was used for a packet. Prototype void IP_RAW_Free( IP_PACKET * pPacket ); Parameter Parameter pPacket Description [IN] Pointer to a packet structure. Table 8.5: IP_RAW_Free() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 214 CHAPTER 8 8.4.4 RAW zero-copy interface IP_RAW_GetDataPtr() Description Returns pointer to data contained in the received RAW packet. Prototype void * IP_RAW_GetDataPtr( const IP_PACKET * pPacket ); Parameter Parameter pPacket Description [IN] Pointer to a packet structure. Table 8.6: IP_RAW_GetDataPtr() parameter list Return value Pointer to the data part of the packet. Additional information The data pointer returned points to the start of the network header. Therefore typically 34 bytes header (14 bytes Ethernet header, 20 bytes IP header) are included. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 215 8.4.5 IP_RAW_GetDataSize() Description Returns size of the payload in the received RAW packet. Prototype U16 IP_RAW_GetDataSize( const IP_PACKET *pPacket ); Parameter Parameter pPacket Description [IN] Pointer to a packet structure. Table 8.7: IP_RAW_GetDataSize() parameter list Return value Number of data bytes received in the packet. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 216 CHAPTER 8 8.4.6 RAW zero-copy interface IP_RAW_GetDestAddr() Description Extracts destination address information from a RAW packet. Prototype void IP_RAW_GetDestAddr( const IP_PACKET * pPacket, void * pDestAddr, int AddrLen ); Parameter Parameter pPacket pDestAddr AddrLen Description [IN] Pointer to a packet structure. [IN] Pointer to a buffer to store the destination address. [IN] Size of the buffer used to store the destination address. Table 8.8: IP_RAW_GetDestAddr() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 217 8.4.7 IP_RAW_GetIFIndex() Description Extracts the interface information from a RAW packet. Prototype unsigned IP_RAW_GetIFIndex ( const IP_PACKET * pPacket ); Parameter Parameter pPacket Description [IN] Pointer to a packet structure. Table 8.9: IP_RAW_GetIFIndex() parameter list Return value Zero-based interface index on which the packet was received. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 218 CHAPTER 8 8.4.8 RAW zero-copy interface IP_RAW_GetSrcAddr() Description Extracts source address information from a RAW packet. Prototype void IP_RAW_GetSrcAddr( const IP_PACKET * pPacket, void * pSrcAddr, int AddrLen ); Parameter Parameter pPacket pSrcAddr AddrLen Description [IN] Pointer to a packet structure. [IN] Pointer to a buffer to store the source address. [IN] Size of the buffer used to store the source address. Table 8.10: IP_RAW_GetSrcAddr() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 219 8.4.9 IP_RAW_Open() Description Creates a RAW connection handle to receive, and pass upwards RAW packets that match the parameters passed. Prototype IP_RAW_CONN IP_RAW_Open( IP_ADDR IP_ADDR U8 int(*routine) void * FAddr, LAddr, Protocol, (IP_PACKET *, void * pContext), pContext ); Parameter Parameter FAddr LAddr Protocol (*routine) pContext Description [IN] Foreign IP address. [IN] Local IP address. [IN] IP protocol. [IN] Callback function which is called when a packet of protocol Protocol is received. [IN/OUT] Application defined context pointer. Table 8.11: IP_RAW_Open() parameter list Return value Success: Returns a pointer to the RAW connection handle. Error: NULL Additional information The parameters FAddr and LAddr can be set to 0 as a wild card, which enables the reception of broadcast packets. To enable reception of any protocol use IPPROTO_RAW for Protocol. The callback handler function is called with a pointer to a received protocol and a copy of the data pointer which is passed to IP_RAW_Open(). This can be any data the programmer requires, such as a pointer to another function, or a control structure to aid in demultiplexing the received packet. The returned handle is used as parameter for IP_RAW_Close() IP_RAW_Close() is not called, there is no need to safe the return value. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP only. If (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 220 CHAPTER 8 RAW zero-copy interface 8.4.10 IP_RAW_Send() Description Send a RAW packet to a specified host. Prototype int IP_RAW_Send( int IP_ADDR U8 IP_PACKET * IFace, FHost, Protocol, pPacket ); Parameter Parameter IFace FHost Protocol pPacket Description [IN] Zero-based index of available interfaces. [IN] IP address of the target host in network endianess. [IN] Protocol that will be used in the IP header generated by the stack. [IN] Packet that should be sent to the target host. Table 8.12: IP_RAW_Send() parameter list Return value On success: 0 On error: Non-zero error code Additional information The packet pPacket has to be allocated by calling IP_RAW_Alloc(). Refer to IP_RAW_Alloc() on page 211 for detailed information. If you expect to get any response to this packet you should have opened a RAW connection prior to calling IP_RAW_Send(). Refer to IP_RAW_Open() on page 219 for more information about creating a RAW connection. IP_RAW_Send() does not free the packet after sending. It is the responsibility of the application programmer to free the packet. Depending on the return value the application programmer can decide if IP_RAW_Free() should be called to free the packet. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 221 8.4.11 IP_RAW_SendAndFree() Description Send a RAW packet to a specified host and frees the packet. Prototype int IP_RAW_SendAndFree( int IP_ADDR U8 IP_PACKET * IFace, FHost, Protocol, pPacket ); Parameter Parameter IFace FHost Protocol pPacket Description [IN] Zero-based index of available interfaces. [IN] IP address of the target host in network endianess. [IN] Protocol that will be used in the IP header generated by the stack. [IN] Packet that should be sent to the target host. Table 8.13: IP_RAW_Send() parameter list Return value On success: 0 On error: Non-zero error code Additional information The packet pPacket has to be allocated by calling IP_RAW_Alloc(). Refer to IP_RAW_Alloc() on page 211 for detailed information. If you expect to get any response to this packet you should have opened a RAW connection prior to calling IP_RAW_Send(). Refer to IP_RAW_Open() on page 219 for more information about creating a RAW connection. Packets are freed by calling IP_RAW_Free() is required. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP IP_RAW_SendAndFree(). Therefor, no call of (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 222 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP CHAPTER 8 RAW zero-copy interface (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 223 Chapter 9 DHCP client This chapter explains the usage of the Dynamic Host Control Protocol (DHCP) with embOS/IP. All API functions are described in this chapter. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 224 9.1 CHAPTER 9 DHCP client DHCP backgrounds DHCP stands for Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol. It is designed to ease configuration management of large networks by allowing the network administrator to collect all the IP hosts "soft" configuration information into a single computer. This includes IP address, name, gateway, and default servers. Refer to [RFC 2131] - DHCP - Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol for detailed information about all settings which can be assigned with DHCP. DHCP is a "client/server" protocol, meaning that machine with the DHCP database "serves" requests from DHCP clients. The clients typically initiate the transaction by requesting an IP address and perhaps other information from the server. The server looks up the client in its database, usually by the client's media address, and assigns the requested fields. Clients do not always need to be in the server's database. If an unknown client submits a request, the server may optionally assign the client a free IP address from a "pool" of free addresses kept for this purpose. The server may also assign the client default information of the local network, such as the default gateway, the DNS server, and routing information. When the IP addresses is assigned, it is "leased" to the client for a finite amount of time. The DHCP client needs to keep track of this lease time, and obtain a lease extension from the server before the lease time runs out. Once the lease has elapsed, the client should not send any more IP packets (except DHCP requests) until he get another address. This approach allows computers (such as laptops or factory floor monitors) which will not be permanently attached to the network to share IP addresses and not hog them when they are not using the net. DHCP is just a superset of the Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP). The main differences between the two are the lease concept, which was created for DHCP, and the ability to assigned addresses from a pool. Refer to [RFC 951] - Bootstrap Protocol for detailed information about the Bootstrap Protocol. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 225 9.2 API functions Function IP_DHCPC_Activate() IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnActivate() IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnFail() IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnLinkDown() IP_DHCPC_GetState() IP_DHCPC_Halt() IP_DHCPC_Renew() IP_DHCPC_SetCallback() Description Activates the DHCP client. Configure behavior on activate. Configure behavior on communication error. Configure behavior on interface link down. Returns the state of the DHCP client. Stops all DHCP client activity. Check configuration with server. Sets a callback for an interface. Table 9.1: embOS/IP DHCP client interface function overview UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 226 CHAPTER 9 9.2.1 DHCP client IP_DHCPC_Activate() Description Activates the DHCP client. Prototype void IP_DHCPC_Activate ( int IFIndex, const char * sHost, const char * sDomain, const char * sVendor ); Parameter Parameter IFIndex sHost sDomain sVendor Description [IN] Zero-based index number specifying the interface which should request configuration information from a DHCP server. [IN] Pointer to host name to use in negotiation. Can be NULL. [IN] Pointer to domain name to use in negotiation. Can be NULL. [IN] Pointer to vendor to use in negotiation. Can be NULL. Table 9.2: IP_DHCPC_Activate() parameter list Additional information This function is typically called from within IP_X_Config(). This function initializes the DHCP client. It attempts to open a UDP connection to listen for incoming replies and begins the process of configuring a network interface using DHCP. The process may take several seconds, and the DHCP client will keep retrying if the service does not respond. The parameters sHost, sDomain, sVendor are optional (can be NULL). If not NULL, must point to a memory area which remains valid after the call since the string is not copied. Example // Correct function call IP_DHCPC_Activate(0, "Target", NULL, NULL); // Illegal function call char ac; sprintf(ac, "Target%d, Index); IP_DHCPC_Activate(0, ac, NULL, NULL); // Correct function call static char ac; sprintf(ac, "Target%d, Index); IP_DHCPC_Activate(0, ac, NULL, NULL); If you start the DHCP client with activated logging the output on the terminal I/O should be similar to the listing below: DHCP: DHCP: DHCP: DHCP: DHCP: DHCP: DHCP: DHCP: DHCP: DHCP: DHCP: DHCP: DHCP: DHCP: DHCP: Sending discover! Received packet from 192.168.1.1 Packet type is OFFER. Renewal time: 2160 min. Rebinding time: 3780 min. Lease time: 4320 min. Host name received. Sending Request. Received packet from 192.168.1.1 Packet type is ACK. Renewal time: 2160 min. Rebinding time: 3780 min. Lease time: 4320 min. Host name received. IFace 0: IP: 192.168.199.20, Mask: 255.255.0.0, GW: 192.168.1.1. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 227 9.2.2 IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnActivate() Description Configures behavior regarding currently set parameters of an interface when the DHCP client is activated on this interface. Prototype void IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnActivate( int IFaceId, U8 Mode ); Parameter Parameter IFaceId Mode Description [IN] Zero-based interface index to configure. [IN] Mode to configure. The modes that can be setup are listed below. Table 9.3: IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnActivate() parameter list Modes Mode DHCPC_RESET_CONFIG DHCPC_USE_STATIC_CONFIG Description Reset interface when activating the DHCP client on this interface to avoid using old settings longer than necessary. Default. Keep previous static configuration, if any, as fallback configuration as long as no new configuration has been received from a server. Table 9.4: IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnActivate() mode list Additional information This function needs to be called before activating the DHCP client for an interface using IP_DHCPC_Activate() on page 226. Please be aware that activating the DHCP client with a static configured IP address instructs the DHCP client to tryto request this address from the server. In case IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnFail() on page 228 is configured to use DHCP_RESET_CONFIG (default) it might happen that the static IP will be reset if no server is reachable or the IP addr. is declined from a server. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 228 CHAPTER 9 9.2.3 DHCP client IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnFail() Description Configures behavior regarding currently set parameters of an interface when the DHCP client fails in communication to negotiate a configuration with a server. Prototype void IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnFail( int IFaceId, U8 Mode ); Parameter Parameter IFaceId Mode Description [IN] Zero-based interface index to configure. [IN] Mode to configure. The modes that can be setup are listed below. Table 9.5: IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnFail() parameter list Modes Mode DHCPC_RESET_CONFIG DHCPC_USE_STATIC_CONFIG DHCPC_USE_DHCP_CONFIG Description Reset interface to avoid using old settings longer than necessary as they might interfere with other DHCP clients in this network. Default. Setup previous static configuration, if any, as fallback configuration to remain accessible. Keep previously received DHCP configuration. Not recommended as it might interfere with other DHCP clients in this network. Table 9.6: IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnFail() mode list Additional information This function shall be called before activating the DHCP client for an interface using IP_DHCPC_Activate() on page 226. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 229 9.2.4 IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnLinkDown() Description Configures behavior regarding currently set parameters of an interface when the DHCP client is activated on this interface and the link goes down. Prototype void IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnLinkDown( int IFaceId, U32 Timeout, U8 Mode ); Parameter Parameter IFaceId Timeout Mode Description [IN] Zero-based interface index to configure. [IN] Timeout to wait before reacting on link down. [IN] Mode to configure. The modes that can be setup are listed below. Table 9.7: IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnLinkDown() parameter list Modes Mode DHCPC_RESET_CONFIG DHCPC_USE_STATIC_CONFIG DHCPC_USE_DHCP_CONFIG Description Reset interface when link goes down on this interface to avoid using old settings longer than necessary as the target might be connected to another network. Default. Setup previous static configuration, if any, as fallback configuration on link down to allow a quick start once the link goes up again. Keep previously received DHCP configuration on link down as long as the configuration is not declined or a new configuration is received once link on this interface is up again. Table 9.8: IP_DHCPC_ConfigOnLinkDown() mode list Additional information This function shall be called before activating the DHCP client for an interface using IP_DHCPC_Activate() on page 226. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 230 CHAPTER 9 9.2.5 DHCP client IP_DHCPC_GetState() Description Returns the state of the DHCP client. Prototype int IP_DHCPC_GetState( int IFIndex ); Parameter Parameter IFIndex Description [IN] Zero-based index number specifying the interface for which the state should be requested. Table 9.9: IP_DHCPC_GetState() parameter list Return value 0 DHCP client not used. >0 DHCP client in use. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 231 9.2.6 IP_DHCPC_Halt() Description Stops all DHCP activity on a network interface. Prototype void IP_DHCPC_Halt( int IFIndex ); Parameter Parameter IFIndex Description [IN] Zero-based index number specifying the interface which should be halted. Table 9.10: IP_DHCPC_Halt() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 232 CHAPTER 9 9.2.7 DHCP client IP_DHCPC_Renew() Description Sends a request with the currently in use DHCP configuration to the DHCP server to check if the configuration is still valid. Prototype void IP_DHCPC_Renew( int IFaceId ); Parameter Parameter IFaceId Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. Table 9.11: IP_DHCPC_Renew() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 233 9.2.8 IP_DHCPC_SetCallback() Description This function allows the caller to set a callback for an interface. Prototype void IP_DHCPC_SetCallback( int IFIndex, int (*routine)(int,int) ); Parameter Parameter IFIndex (*routine) Description [IN] Zero-based index number of available network interfaces. [IN] Callback functions which should be called with every status change. Table 9.12: IP_DHCPC_SetCallback() parameter list Additional information The callback is called with every status change. This mechanism is provided so that the caller can do some processing when the interface is up (like doing initialization or blinking LEDs, etc.). Refer to [RFC 2331] DHCP - Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol for detailed information about DHCP states. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 234 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP CHAPTER 9 DHCP client (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 235 Chapter 10 DHCP server (Add-on) The embOS/IPThis implementation of the DHCP server is an optional extension to embOS/IP. It allows setting up a Dynamic Host Control Protocol (DHCP) server that seamlessly integrates with embOS/IP. All API functions are described in this chapter. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 236 CHAPTER 10 DHCP server (Add-on) 10.1 DHCP backgrounds DHCP stands for Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol. It is designed to ease configuration management of large networks by allowing the network administrator to collect all the IP hosts "soft" configuration information into a single computer. This includes IP address, name, gateway, and default servers. Refer to [RFC 2131] - DHCP - Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol for detailed information about all settings which can be assigned with DHCP. Further information can be found in the chapter DHCP backgrounds on page 224 in the description of the DHCP client. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 237 10.2 API functions Function IP_DHCPS_ConfigDNSAddr() IP_DHCPS_ConfigGWAddr() IP_DHCPS_ConfigMaxLeaseTime() IP_DHCPS_ConfigPool() IP_DHCPS_Halt() IP_DHCPS_Init() IP_DHCPS_Start() Description Configure the DNS servers to distribute. Configure the gateway to distribute. Configure the max. lease time to grant. Configures the IP pool to use. Halts the DHCP server. Initializes the DHCP server. Starts the DHCP server. Table 10.1: embOS/IP DHCP server interface function overview UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 238 CHAPTER 10 DHCP server (Add-on) 10.2.1 IP_DHCPS_ConfigDNSAddr() Description Configures DNS servers to assign to clients. Prototype int IP_DHCPS_ConfigDNSAddr ( unsigned IFIndex, U32 *paDNSAddr, U8 NumServers ); Parameter Parameter IFIndex paDNSAddr NumServers Description [IN] Zero-based interface index on which the server will be running. [IN] Array of IPv4 addresses of DNS servers to use. [IN] Number of DNS servers in array. Table 10.2: IP_DHCPS_ConfigDNSAddr() parameter list Return value 0: O.K. Other: Error. Additional information Configuring DNS server settings is optional. If no DNS servers are configured no DNS servers will be assigned to clients. Needs to be called before activating the DHCP server for this interface with IP_DHCPS_Start() on page 244. Example U32 aDNSAddr[2]; // // Setup DNS addr. as needed. // aDNSAddr[0] = IP_BYTES2ADDR(192, 168, 12, 1); aDNSAddr[1] = IP_BYTES2ADDR(192, 168, 12, 2); IP_DHCPS_ConfigDNSAddr(0, &aDNSAddr[0], 2); IP_DHCPS_ConfigPool(0, IP_BYTES2ADDR(192, 168, 12, 11), 0xFFFF0000, 20); IP_DHCPS_Init(0); IP_DHCPS_Start(0); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 239 10.2.2 IP_DHCPS_ConfigGWAddr() Description Configures the gateway addr. that will be assign to clients. Prototype int IP_DHCPS_ConfigGWAddr ( unsigned IFIndex, U32 GWAddr ); Parameter Parameter IFIndex GWAddr Description [IN] Zero-based interface index on which the server will be running. [IN] IP addr. of gateway. Table 10.3: IP_DHCPS_ConfigGWAddr() parameter list Return value 0: O.K. Other: Error. Additional information Configuring a gateway setting is optional. If no gateway is configured no gateway will be assigned to clients. Needs to be called before activating the DHCP server for this interface with IP_DHCPS_Start() on page 244. Example IP_DHCPS_ConfigGWAddr(0, IP_BYTES2ADDR(192, 168, 12, 1)); IP_DHCPS_ConfigPool(0, IP_BYTES2ADDR(192, 168, 12, 11), 0xFFFF0000, 20); IP_DHCPS_Init(0); IP_DHCPS_Start(0); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 240 CHAPTER 10 DHCP server (Add-on) 10.2.3 IP_DHCPS_ConfigMaxLeaseTime() Description Configures the maximum lease time that a client will be granted to use the achieved configuration. Prototype int IP_DHCPS_ConfigMaxLeaseTime ( unsigned IFIndex, U32 Seconds ); Parameter Parameter IFIndex Seconds Description [IN] Zero-based interface index on which the server will be running. [IN] Maximum lease time in seconds. Default 7200s => 2h. Table 10.4: IP_DHCPS_ConfigMaxLeaseTime() parameter list Return value 0: O.K. Other: Error. Additional information Optional. Needs to be called before activating the DHCP server for this interface with IP_DHCPS_Start() on page 244. Example IP_DHCPS_ConfigMaxLeaseTime(0, 7200); IP_DHCPS_ConfigPool(0, IP_BYTES2ADDR(192, 168, 12, 11), 0xFFFF0000, 20); IP_DHCPS_Init(0); IP_DHCPS_Start(0); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 241 10.2.4 IP_DHCPS_ConfigPool() Description Configures the IP address pool that can be assigned to DHCP clients. Prototype int IP_DHCPS_ConfigPool ( unsigned U32 U32 U32 IFIndex, StartIPAddr, SNMask, PoolSize ); Parameter Parameter IFIndex StartIPAddr SNMask PoolSize Description [IN] [IN] [IN] [IN] Zero-based interface index on which the server will be running. First IP addr. of the pool. Subnet mask to assign to clients. Number of IP addresses in pool starting from StartIPAddr. Table 10.5: IP_DHCPS_ConfigPool() parameter list Return value 0: O.K. Other: Error. Additional information Needs to be called before activating the DHCP server for this interface with IP_DHCPS_Start() on page 244. Example IP_DHCPS_ConfigPool(0, IP_BYTES2ADDR(192, 168, 12, 11), 0xFFFF0000, 20); IP_DHCPS_Init(0); IP_DHCPS_Start(0); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 242 CHAPTER 10 DHCP server (Add-on) 10.2.5 IP_DHCPS_Halt() Description Halts the DHCP server on a specific interface. Prototype void IP_DHCPS_Halt ( unsigned IFIndex ); Parameter Parameter IFIndex Description [IN] Zero-based interface index on which the server is running. Table 10.6: IP_DHCPS_Halt() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 243 10.2.6 IP_DHCPS_Init() Description Initializes a DHCP server instance for an interface. Prototype int IP_DHCPS_Init ( unsigned IFIndex ); Parameter Parameter IFIndex Description [IN] Zero-based interface index on which the server will be running. Table 10.7: IP_DHCPS_Init() parameter list Return value 0: O.K. Other: Error. Additional information Needs to be called before activating the DHCP server for this interface with IP_DHCPS_Start() on page 244. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 244 CHAPTER 10 DHCP server (Add-on) 10.2.7 IP_DHCPS_Start() Description Starts a DHCP server instance on an interface. Prototype int IP_DHCPS_Start ( unsigned IFIndex ); Parameter Parameter IFIndex Description [IN] Zero-based interface index on which the server will be running. Table 10.8: IP_DHCPS_Start() parameter list Return value 0: O.K. Other: Error. Additional information IP_DHCPS_Init() on page 243 and IP_DHCPS_ConfigPool() on page 241 need to be called before activating the DHCP server for an interface in order to set at least the minimum configurations. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 245 10.3 DHCP server resource usage The ROM usage depends on the compiler options, the compiler version and the used CPU. The memory requirements of the DHCP server modules presented in the tables below have been measured on an ARM7 and a Cortex-M3 system. Details about the further configuration can be found in the sections of the specific example. 10.3.1 ROM usage on an ARM7 system The following resource usage has been measured on an ARM7 system using IAR Embedded Workbench V6.30.6, Thumb mode, no interwork, size optimization. Addon embOS/IP DHCP server ROM approximately 2.0Kbyte Table 10.9: DHCP server ROM usage ARM7 10.3.2 ROM usage on a Cortex-M3 system The following resource usage has been measured on a Cortex-M3 system using IAR Embedded Workbench V6.30.6, size optimization. Addon embOS/IP DHCP server ROM approximately 2.0Kbyte Table 10.10: DHCP server ROM usage Cortex-M3 10.3.3 RAM usage Addon embOS/IP DHCP server RAM approximately 200 bytes Table 10.11: DHCP server RAM usage UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 246 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP CHAPTER 10 DHCP server (Add-on) (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 247 Chapter 11 AutoIP All functions which are required to add AutoIP to your application are described in this chapter. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 248 CHAPTER 11 AutoIP 11.1 embOS/IP AutoIP backgrounds The embOS/IP AutoIP module adds the dynamic configuration of IPv4 Link-Local addresses to embOS/IP. This functionality is better known as AutoIP. Therefore, this term will be used in this document. The AutoIP implementation covers the relevant parts of the following RFCs: RFC# [RFC 3972] Description Dynamic Configuration of IPv4 Link-Local Addresses. Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc3972.txt In general AutoIP is a method to negotiate a IPv4 address in a network without the utilization of a server such as a DHCP server. AutoIP will try to use IPv4 addresses out of a reserved pool from the addresses 169.254.1.0 to 169.254.254.255 to find a free IP that is not used by any other network participant at this time. To achieve this goal AutoIP sends ARP probes into the network to ask if the addr. to be used is already in use. This is determined by an ARP reply for the requested address. Upon an address conflict AutoIP will generate a new address to use and will retry to use it by sending ARP probes again. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 249 11.2 API functions Function IP_AutoIP_Activate() IP_AutoIP_Halt() IP_AutoIP_SetUserCallback() IP_AutoIP_SetStartIP() Description Activates AutoIP. Stops all AutoIP activity. Sets a callback to get a notification about each status change. Sets the IP address which will be used for the first configuration try. Table 11.1: embOS/IP AutoIP interface function overview UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 250 CHAPTER 11 AutoIP 11.2.1 IP_AutoIP_Activate() Description Activates AutoIP for the specified interface. Prototype void IP_AutoIP_Activate ( unsigned IFaceId ); Parameter Parameter IFaceId Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. Table 11.2: IP_AutoIP_Activate() parameter list Additional information Activating the dynamic configuration of IPv4 Link-Local addresses means that an additional timer will be added to the stack. This timer will be called every second to check the status of the address configuration. With the AutoIP activation an IP address for the dynamic configuration will be created. The IPv4 prefix 169.254/16 is registered with the IANA for this purpose. This means that embOS/IP will generate an IP address similar to 169.254.xxx.xxx. The subnet mask of is always 255.255.0.0. In embOS/IP debug builds terminal I/O output can be enabled. AutoIP outputs status information in the terminal I/O window if the stack is configured to so (IP_MTYPE_AUTOIP added to the log filter mask). Please refer to IP_SetLogFilter() on page 547 and IP_AddLogFilter() on page 545 for further information about the enabling terminal I/O. If terminal I/O is enabled the output of a the program start should be similar to the following lines: 0:000 0:000 0:000 0:000 0:000 0:000 3:000 9:000 9:000 MainTask - INIT: Init started. Version 2.00.06 MainTask - DRIVER: Found PHY with Id 0x2000 at addr 0x1 MainTask - INIT: Link is down MainTask - INIT: Init completed IP_Task - INIT: IP_Task started IP_RxTask - INIT: IP_RxTask started IP_Task - LINK: Link state changed: Full duplex, 100 MHz IP_Task - AutoIP: 169.254.240.240 checked, no conflicts IP_Task - AutoIP: IFaceId 0: Using IP: 169.254.240.240. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 251 11.2.2 IP_AutoIP_Halt() Description Stops AutoIP activity for the passed interface. Prototype void IP_AutoIP_Halt ( unsigned IFaceId U8 KeepIP ); Parameter Parameter IFaceId KeepIP Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. [IN] Flag to indicate if the used IP address should be stored for the next start of AutoIP. 0 means do not keep the IP, 1 means keep the IP address for the next AutoIP start. Table 11.3: IP_AutoIP_Halt() parameter list Return value 0 : Ok. AutoIP stopped. IP address cleared. IP : Ok. AutoIP stopped. The IP address (for example, 0xA9FExxxx) has been kept. -1 : Error. Illegal interface number. Additional information The function stops the AutoIP module. The IP address which was used during AutoIP was activated, can be kept to speed up the configuration process after reactivating AutoIP. If the IP address will not be kept, AutoIP creates a new IP address after the reactivation. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 252 CHAPTER 11 AutoIP 11.2.3 IP_AutoIP_SetUserCallback() Description Sets a callback function. It will be called with every status change. Prototype void IP_AutoIP_SetUserCallback( unsigned IFaceId, IP_AUTOIP_INFORM_USER_FUNC * pfInformUser ); Parameter Parameter IFaceId pfInformUser Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. [IN] Pointer to a user function of type IP_AUTOIP_INFORM_USER_FUNC which is called when a status change occurs. Table 11.4: IP_AutoIP_SetCallback() parameter list Additional Information The possibility to set a callback function is provided so that the caller can do some processing when the interface is up (like doing initializations or blinking LEDs, etc.). IP_AUTOIP_INFORM_USER_FUNC is defined as follows: typedef void (IP_AUTOIP_INFORM_USER_FUNC)(U32 IFaceId, U32 Status); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 253 11.2.4 IP_AutoIP_SetStartIP() Description Sets the IP address which will be used for the first configuration try. Prototype void IP_AutoIP_SetStartIP( unsigned IFaceId, U32 IPAddr ); Parameter Parameter IFaceId IPAddr Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. [IN] 4-byte IPv4 address. Table 11.5: IP_AutoIP_SetCallback() parameter list Additional information A call of this function is normally not required, but in some cases it can be useful to set the IP address which should be used as starting point of the AutoIP functionality. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 254 CHAPTER 11 AutoIP 11.3 AutoIP resource usage The ROM usage depends on the compiler options, the compiler version and the used CPU. The memory requirements of the AutoIP module presented in the tables below have been measured on an ARM7 and a Cortex-M3 system. Details about the further configuration can be found in the sections of the specific example. 11.3.1 ROM usage on an ARM7 system The following resource usage has been measured on an ARM7 system using IAR Embedded Workbench V6.30.6, Thumb mode, no interwork, size optimization. Addon embOS/IP AutoIP module ROM approximately 1.1Kbyte Table 11.6: AutoIP ROM usage ARM7 11.3.2 ROM usage on a Cortex-M3 system The following resource usage has been measured on a Cortex-M3 system using IAR Embedded Workbench V6.30.6, size optimization. Addon embOS/IP AutoIP module ROM approximately 1.0Kbyte Table 11.7: AutoIP ROM usage Cortex-M3 11.3.3 RAM usage Addon embOS/IP AutoIP module RAM approximately 0.7Kbyte Table 11.8: AutoIP RAM usage UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 255 Chapter 12 Address Collision Detection All functions which are required to add Address Collision Detection (ACD) to your application are described in this chapter. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 256 CHAPTER 12 Address Collision Detection 12.1 embOS/IP ACD backgrounds The embOS/IP ACD module allows the user specific configuration of the behavior if an IPv4 address collision is detected. This means that more than one host in the network is using the same IPv4 address at the same time. This is discovered sending ARP discover packets to find hosts with the same addresses in the network. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 257 12.2 API functions Function IP_ACD_Activate() IP_ACD_Config() Description Activates ACD. Configures parameter for ACD. Table 12.1: embOS/IP ACD interface function overview UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 258 CHAPTER 12 Address Collision Detection 12.2.1 IP_ACD_Activate() Description Activates ACD for the specified interface. Prototype int IP_ACD_Activate ( unsigned IFace ); Parameter Parameter IFace Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. Table 12.2: IP_ACD_Activate() parameter list Return value 0 ACD activated and free IP found (does not mean the initial IP was good) 1 No IP address set when ACD was activated Additional information Activating the address conflict detection module means that a a hook into the ARP module of the stack will be activated that allows the user to take action if an IPv4 address conflict on the network has been discovered. When the ACD module is started it will check if the currently used IP address is in conflict with any other host on the network by sending ARP probes to find hosts with the same IPv4 address. To allow the user to take action on those conflicts it is necessary to use IP_ACD_Config() on page 259 before activating ACD. In embOS/IP debug builds terminal I/O output can be enabled. ACD outputs status information in the terminal I/O window if the stack is configured to so (IP_MTYPE_ACD added to the log filter mask). Please refer to IP_SetLogFilter() on page 547 and IP_AddLogFilter() on page 545 for further information about the enabling terminal I/ O. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 259 12.2.2 IP_ACD_Config() Description Configures ACD behavior for startup and in case of conflicts. Prototype void IP_ACD_Config ( unsigned unsigned unsigned const ADC_FUNC * IFace ProbeNum DefendInterval pACDContext ); Parameter Parameter IFace ProbeNum DefendInterval pACDContext Description [IN] Zero-based interface index. [IN] Number of ARP probes to send upon activating ACD before declaring the actual used IP address to be free to be used. [IN] Interval in which the currently active IP address is being known as defended after taking action. [IN] Pointer to a structure of type ACD_FUNC. Table 12.3: IP_ACD_Config() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 260 CHAPTER 12 Address Collision Detection 12.3 ACD data structures 12.3.1 Structure ACD_FUNC Description Used to store function pointers to the user defined callbacks to take several actions upon detecting an IP address conflict. Prototype typedef struct ACD_FUNC { U32 (*pfRenewIPAddr); int (*pfDefend); int (*pfRestart); } ACD_FUNC; Member Description Function pointer to a user defined routine that is used to generate a pfRenewIPAddr new IPv4 address if there is a collision detected during ACD activation. Function pointer to a user defined routine that is used to let the pfDefend user implement his own defend strategy. Can be NULL. Function pointer to a user defined routine that should reconfigure pfRestart the IP address used by the stack and optionally re-activates ACD. Table 12.4: Structure ACD_FUNC member list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 261 12.4 ACD resource usage The ROM usage depends on the compiler options, the compiler version and the used CPU. The memory requirements of the AutoIP module presented in the tables below have been measured on an ARM7 and a Cortex-M3 system. Details about the further configuration can be found in the sections of the specific example. 12.4.1 ROM usage on an ARM7 system The following resource usage has been measured on an ARM7 system using IAR Embedded Workbench V6.30.6, Thumb mode, no interwork, size optimization. Addon embOS/IP ACD module ROM approximately 0.4Kbyte Table 12.5: ACD ROM usage ARM7 12.4.2 ROM usage on a Cortex-M3 system The following resource usage has been measured on a Cortex-M3 system using IAR Embedded Workbench V6.30.6, size optimization. Addon embOS/IP ACD module ROM approximately 0.4Kbyte Table 12.6: ACD ROM usage Cortex-M3 12.4.3 RAM usage Addon embOS/IP ACD module RAM approximately 50Bytes Table 12.7: ACD RAM usage UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 262 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP CHAPTER 12 Address Collision Detection (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 263 Chapter 13 UPnP (Add-on) The embOS/IP implementation of UPnP which stand for Universal Plug and Play is an optional extension to embOS/IP. It allows making your target easily discoverable and advertising services available on your target throughout your network. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 264 CHAPTER 13 UPnP (Add-on) 13.1 embOS/IP UPnP The embOS/IP UPnP implementation is an optional extension which can be seamlessly integrated into your TCP/IP application. It combines the possibility to implemented UPnP services in a most flexible way by allowing to specify content to be sent upon UPnP requests completely generated by the application with a small memory footprint. The UPnP module implements the relevant parts of the UPnP documentation released by the UPnP Forum. Document UPnP Device Architecture 1.0 Download Direct download: http://upnp.org/specs/arch/UPnParch-DeviceArchitecture-v1.0.pdf The following table shows the contents of the embOS/IP root directory: Directory Content Application Contains the example application to run the UPnP implementation with embOS/IP and embOS/IP Web server add-on. IP Contains the UPnP source file, IP_UPnP.c . Supplied directory structure of embOS/IP UPnP package UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 265 13.2 Feature list * * * Low memory footprint. Advertising your services on the network Easy to implement UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 266 CHAPTER 13 UPnP (Add-on) 13.3 Requirements TCP/IP stack The embOS/IP UPnP implementation requires the embOS/IP TCP/IP stack and is designed to be used with the embOS/IP Web server add-on. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 267 13.4 UPnP backgrounds UPnP is designed to provide services throughout a network without interaction of the user. It is designed to use standardised protocols such as IP, TCP, UDP, Multicast, HTTP and XML for communication and to dirstribute services provided by a device. UPnP can be used to advertise services provided by a device across the network such as where to find the web interface for the device advertising. Newer operating systems support UPnP from scratch and will show UPnP devices available across a network and may provide easy access to a device by simply selecting the discovered UPnP device. A typical usage would be to advertise media accessible on a media storage on the network and opening a file browser window to the resource upon opening the UPnP entry discovered. 13.4.1 Using UPnP to advertise your service in the network The default UPnP XML file advertised is upnp.xml. A solution providing UPnP content has to serve a file called upnp.xml containing valid UPnP descriptors via a web server. The sample OS_IP_Webserver_UPnP.c provides a sample configuration for advertising a web server page that will open if the UPnP client clicks on the discovered UPnP device. A discovered UPnP device will typically be shown in the network neighborhood of your operating system. A discovered device found by a Windows OS is shown in the picture below: The example below shows the most important excerpts from the OS_IP_Webserver_UPnP.c sample that are necessary to setup a UPnP device in your network. Example The sample provides some easy to use defines to adopt the identification strings used by the UPnP device to advertise itself to be changed to your needs. /* Excerpt from OS_IP_Webserver_UPnP.c */ // // UPnP // #define UPNP_FRIENDLY_NAME "SEGGER UPnP Demo" #define UPNP_MANUFACTURER "SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH and Co. KG" // '&' is not allowed #define UPNP_MANUFACTURER_URL "http://www.segger.com" #define UPNP_MODEL_DESC "SEGGER Web server with UPnP" #define UPNP_MODEL_NAME "SEGGER UPnP Demo" #define UPNP_MODEL_URL "http://www.segger.com/embos-ip-webserver.html" The sample uses VFile hooks as described in IP_WEBS_AddVFileHook() on page 384 to provide dynamically serving the necessary XML files for UPnP without the need for a real file system or further processing through the web server. /* Excerpt from OS_IP_Webserver_UPnP.c */ /********************************************************************* * * Types * ********************************************************************** */ typedef struct { const char * sFileName; const char * pData; UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 268 CHAPTER 13 unsigned } VFILE_LIST; UPnP (Add-on) NumBytes; /* Excerpt from OS_IP_Webserver_UPnP.c */ /********************************************************************* * * Static const * ********************************************************************** */ // // UPnP, virtual files // static const char _acFile_dummy_xml[] = "\r\n" "\r\n" "\r\n" "1\r\n" "0\r\n" "\r\n" "\r\n" "\r\n" "Dummy\r\n" "i1\r\n" "\r\n" "\r\n" ""; // // UPnP, virtual files list // static const VFILE_LIST _VFileList[] = { "/dummy.xml", _acFile_dummy_xml, sizeof(_acFile_dummy_xml) - 1, the null terminator of the string NULL , NULL , NULL }; // Do not count in /* Excerpt from OS_IP_Webserver_UPnP.c */ // // UPnP webserver VFile hook // static WEBS_VFILE_HOOK _UPnP_VFileHook; Several helper functions are provided in the sample to easily generate a valid XML file for advertising a service using UPnP. /* Excerpt from OS_IP_Webserver_UPnP.c */ // // UPnP // #define UPNP_FRIENDLY_NAME "SEGGER UPnP Demo" #define UPNP_MANUFACTURER "SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH and Co. KG" // '&' is not allowed #define UPNP_MANUFACTURER_URL "http://www.segger.com" #define UPNP_MODEL_DESC "SEGGER Web server with UPnP" #define UPNP_MODEL_NAME "SEGGER UPnP Demo" #define UPNP_MODEL_URL "http://www.segger.com/embos-ip-webserver.html" /* Excerpt from OS_IP_Webserver_UPnP.c */ /********************************************************************* * * Static code * ********************************************************************** */ /********************************************************************* UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 269 * * _UPnP_GetURLBase * * Function description * This function copies the information needed for the URLBase parameter * into the given buffer and returns a pointer to the start of the buffer * for easy readable code. * * Parameters * pBuffer - Pointer to the buffer that can be temporarily used to * store the requested data. * NumBytes - Size of the given buffer used for checks * * Return value * Pointer to the start of the buffer used for storage. */ static const char * _UPnP_GetURLBase(char * pBuffer, unsigned NumBytes) { #define URL_BASE_PREFIX "http://" char * p; p = pBuffer; *p = '\0'; // Just to be on the safe if the buffer is too small strncpy(pBuffer, URL_BASE_PREFIX, NumBytes); p += (sizeof(URL_BASE_PREFIX) - 1); NumBytes -= (sizeof(URL_BASE_PREFIX) - 1); IP_PrintIPAddr(p, IP_GetIPAddr(INTERFACE), NumBytes); return pBuffer; } /********************************************************************* * * _UPnP_GetModelNumber * * Function description * This function copies the information needed for the ModelNumber parameter * into the given buffer and returns a pointer to the start of the buffer * for easy readable code. * * Parameters * pBuffer - Pointer to the buffer that can be temporarily used to * store the requested data. * NumBytes - Size of the given buffer used for checks * * Return value * Pointer to the start of the buffer used for storage. */ static const char * _UPnP_GetModelNumber(char * pBuffer, unsigned NumBytes) { U8 aHWAddr[6]; if (NumBytes <= 12) { *pBuffer = '\0'; // Just to be on the safe if the buffer is too small } else { IP_GetHWAddr(INTERFACE, aHWAddr, sizeof(aHWAddr)); snprintf(pBuffer, NumBytes, "%02X%02X%02X%02X%02X%02X", aHWAddr[0], aHWAddr[1], aHWAddr[2], aHWAddr[3], aHWAddr[4], aHWAddr[5]); } return pBuffer; } /********************************************************************* * * _UPnP_GetSN * * Function description * This function copies the information needed for the SerialNumber parameter * into the given buffer and returns a pointer to the start of the buffer UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 270 CHAPTER 13 UPnP (Add-on) * for easy readable code. * * Parameters * pBuffer - Pointer to the buffer that can be temporarily used to * store the requested data. * NumBytes - Size of the given buffer used for checks * * Return value * Pointer to the start of the buffer used for storage. */ static const char * _UPnP_GetSN(char * pBuffer, unsigned NumBytes) { U8 aHWAddr[6]; if (NumBytes <= 12) { *pBuffer = '\0'; // Just to be on the safe if the buffer is too small } else { IP_GetHWAddr(INTERFACE, aHWAddr, sizeof(aHWAddr)); snprintf(pBuffer, NumBytes, "%02X%02X%02X%02X%02X%02X", aHWAddr[0], aHWAddr[1], aHWAddr[2], aHWAddr[3], aHWAddr[4], aHWAddr[5]); } return pBuffer; } /********************************************************************* * * _UPnP_GetUDN * * Function description * This function copies the information needed for the UDN parameter * into the given buffer and returns a pointer to the start of the buffer * for easy readable code. * * Parameters * pBuffer - Pointer to the buffer that can be temporarily used to * store the requested data. * NumBytes - Size of the given buffer used for checks * * Return value * Pointer to the start of the buffer used for storage. */ static const char * _UPnP_GetUDN(char * pBuffer, unsigned NumBytes) { #define UDN_PREFIX "uuid:95232DE0-3AF7-11E2-81C1-" char * p; U8 aHWAddr[6]; p = pBuffer; *pBuffer = '\0'; // Just to be on the safe if the buffer is too small strncpy(pBuffer, UDN_PREFIX, NumBytes); p += (sizeof(UDN_PREFIX) - 1); NumBytes -= (sizeof(UDN_PREFIX) - 1); if (NumBytes > 12) { IP_GetHWAddr(INTERFACE, aHWAddr, sizeof(aHWAddr)); snprintf(p, NumBytes, "%02X%02X%02X%02X%02X%02X", aHWAddr[0], aHWAddr[1], aHWAddr[2], aHWAddr[3], aHWAddr[4], aHWAddr[5]); } return pBuffer; } /********************************************************************* * * _UPnP_GetPresentationURL * * Function description * This function copies the information needed for the presentation URL parameter * into the given buffer and returns a pointer to the start of the buffer * for easy readable code. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 271 * * Parameters * pBuffer - Pointer to the buffer that can be temporarily used to * store the requested data. * NumBytes - Size of the given buffer used for checks * * Return value * Pointer to the start of the buffer used for storage. */ static const char * _UPnP_GetPresentationURL(char * pBuffer, unsigned NumBytes) { #define PRESENTATION_URL_PREFIX "http://" #define PRESENTATION_URL_POSTFIX "/index.htm" char * p; int i; p = pBuffer; *p = '\0'; // Just to be on the safe if the buffer is too small strncpy(pBuffer, PRESENTATION_URL_PREFIX, NumBytes); p += (sizeof(PRESENTATION_URL_PREFIX) - 1); NumBytes -= (sizeof(PRESENTATION_URL_PREFIX) - 1); i = IP_PrintIPAddr(p, IP_GetIPAddr(INTERFACE), NumBytes); p += i; NumBytes -= i; strncat(pBuffer, PRESENTATION_URL_POSTFIX, NumBytes); return pBuffer; } /********************************************************************* * * _UPnP_GenerateSend_upnp_xml * * Function description * Send the content for the requested file using the callback provided. * * Parameters * pContextIn - Send context of the connection processed for * forwarding it to the callback used for output. * pf - Function pointer to the callback that has to be * for sending the content of the VFile. * pContextOut - Out context of the connection processed. * pData - Pointer to the data that will be sent * NumBytes - Number of bytes to send from pData. If NumBytes * is passed as 0 the send function will run a strlen() * on pData expecting a string. * * Notes * (1) The data does not need to be sent in one call of the callback * routine. The data can be sent in blocks of data and will be * flushed out automatically at least once returning from this * routine. */ static void _UPnP_GenerateSend_upnp_xml(void * pContextIn, void (*pf) (void * pContextOut, const char * pData, unsigned NumBytes)) { char ac[128]; pf(pContextIn, "\r\n" "\r\n" "\r\n" "1\r\n" "0\r\n" "\r\n" , 0); pf(pContextIn, Base>" pf(pContextIn, UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP _UPnP_GetURLBase(ac, "\r\n" , 0); pf(pContextIn, "\r\n" "urn:schemas-upnp-org:device:Basic:1\r\n" , 0); pf(pContextIn, "" UPNP_FRIENDLY_NAME "\r\n" , 0); pf(pContextIn, "" UPNP_MANUFACTURER "\r\n" , 0); pf(pContextIn, "" UPNP_MANUFACTURER_URL "\r\n" , 0); pf(pContextIn, "" UPNP_MODEL_DESC "\r\n" , 0); pf(pContextIn, "" UPNP_MODEL_NAME "\r\n" , 0); pf(pContextIn, ber>" "\r\n" , 0); pf(pContextIn, lURL>\r\n" "" , 0); UPNP_MODEL_URL pf(pContextIn, ber>" "\r\n" "" , 0); pf(pContextIn, _UPnP_GetUDN(ac, sizeof(ac)) , 0); pf(pContextIn, "\r\n" , 0); pf(pContextIn, "\r\n" "\r\n" "urn:schemas-upnp-org:service:Dummy:1\r\n" "urn:upnp-org:serviceId:Dummy\r\n" "/dummy.xml\r\n" "/\r\n" "\r\n" "\r\n" "\r\n" pf(pContextIn, URL>" pf(pContextIn, "\r\n" pf(pContextIn, "\r\n" "" , 0); } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 273 The callbacks for providing a virtual file using a VFile hook allow providing dynamically created content for every file requested from the web server as soon as possible. A file served from a VFile hook will not be processed further by the web server code. /* Excerpt from OS_IP_Webserver_UPnP.c */ /********************************************************************* * * Static code * ********************************************************************** */ /********************************************************************* * * _UPnP_CheckVFile * * Function description * Check if we have content that we can deliver for the requested * file using the VFile hook system. * * Parameters * sFileName - Name of the file that is requested * pIndex - Pointer to a variable that has to be filled with * the index of the entry found in case of using a * filename<=>content list. * Alternative all comparisons can be done using the * filename. In this case the index is meaningless * and does not need to be returned by this routine. * * Return value * 0 - We do not have content to send for this filename, * fall back to the typical methods for retrieving * a file from the web server. * 1 - We have content that can be sent using the VFile * hook system. */ static int _UPnP_CheckVFile(const char * sFileName, unsigned * pIndex) { unsigned i; // // Generated VFiles // if (strcmp(sFileName, "/upnp.xml") == 0) { return 1; } // // Static VFiles // for (i = 0; i < SEGGER_COUNTOF(_VFileList); i++) { if (strcmp(sFileName, _VFileList[i].sFileName) == 0) { *pIndex = i; return 1; } } return 0; } /********************************************************************* * * _UPnP_SendVFile * * Function description * Send the content for the requested file using the callback provided. * * Parameters * pContextIn - Send context of the connection processed for UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 274 CHAPTER 13 UPnP (Add-on) * forwarding it to the callback used for output. * Index - Index of the entry of a filename<=>content list * if used. Alternative all comparisons can be done * using the filename. In this case the index is * meaningless. If using a filename<=>content list * this is faster than searching again. * sFileName - Name of the file that is requested. In case of * working with the Index this is meaningless. * pf - Function pointer to the callback that has to be * for sending the content of the VFile. * pContextOut - Out context of the connection processed. * pData - Pointer to the data that will be sent * NumBytes - Number of bytes to send from pData. If NumBytes * is passed as 0 the send function will run a strlen() * on pData expecting a string. */ static void _UPnP_SendVFile(void * pContextIn, unsigned Index, const char * sFileName, void (*pf) (void * pContextOut, const char * pData, unsigned NumBytes)) { (void)sFileName; // // Generated VFiles // if (strcmp(sFileName, "/upnp.xml") == 0) { _UPnP_GenerateSend_upnp_xml(pContextIn, pf); return; } // // Static VFiles // pf(pContextIn, _VFileList[Index].pData, _VFileList[Index].NumBytes); } static WEBS_VFILE_APPLICATION _UPnP_VFileAPI = { _UPnP_CheckVFile, _UPnP_SendVFile }; All that is needed to be added to your application in order to provide the necessary XML files through embOS/IP Web server and starting UPnP advertising are the following lines: /* Excerpt from OS_IP_Webserver_UPnP.c */ // // Activate UPnP with VFile hook for needed XML files // IP_WEBS_AddVFileHook(&_UPnP_VFileHook, &_UPnP_VFileAPI); IP_UPNP_Activate(INTERFACE, NULL); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 275 13.5 API functions Function IP_UPNP_Activate() Description Activates UPnP advertisement of the target in the network. Table 13.1: embOS/IP UPnP API function overview UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 276 CHAPTER 13 UPnP (Add-on) 13.5.1 IP_UPNP_Activate() Description Activates the UPnP server. Prototype void IP_UPNP_Activate( unsigned IFace, const char * acUDN ); Parameter Parameter IFace acUDN Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces. [IN] String containing a unique descriptor name. (Optional, can be NULL.) Table 13.2: IP_UPNP_Activate() parameter list Additional infromation If acUDN is NULL the unique descriptor name will be generated from the HW addr. of the interface. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 277 13.6 UPnP resource usage The ROM usage depends on the compiler options, the compiler version and the used CPU. The memory requirements of the UPnP modules presented in the tables below have been measured on an ARM7 and a Cortex-M3 system. Details about the further configuration can be found in the sections of the specific example. The pure size of the UPnP add-on has been measured as the size of the services provided may vary. 13.6.1 ROM usage on an ARM7 system The following resource usage has been measured on an ARM7 system using IAR Embedded Workbench V6.30.6, Thumb mode, no interwork, size optimization. Addon embOS/IP UPnP ROM approximately 2.2Kbyte Table 13.3: UPnP ROM usage ARM7 13.6.2 ROM usage on a Cortex-M3 system The following resource usage has been measured on a Cortex-M3 system using IAR Embedded Workbench V6.30.6, size optimization. Addon embOS/IP UPnP ROM approximately 2.0Kbyte Table 13.4: UPnP ROM usage Cortex-M3 13.6.3 RAM usage Addon embOS/IP UPnP RAM approximately 170 bytes Table 13.5: UPnP RAM usage UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 278 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP CHAPTER 13 UPnP (Add-on) (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 279 Chapter 14 VLAN The embOS/IP implementation of VLAN which stand for Virtual LAN allows seperating your network into multiple networks without the need to seperate it physically. This chapter will show you how easily VLAN access can be setup on your target. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 280 CHAPTER 14 VLAN 14.1 embOS/IP VLAN The embOS/IP VLAN implementation allows a fast and easy implement of VLAN on your target. embOS/IP VLAN support supports a basic VLAN tag specifying only a VLAN ID. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 281 14.2 Feature list * * * Low memory footprint. Easy to implement. Software based solution without the need for a driver to support VLAN tags. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 282 CHAPTER 14 VLAN 14.3 VLAN backgrounds VLAN technology can be used to seperate multiple devices operating on the same physical network into completely seperated networks without seeing each other. A typical usage would be to have 2 departments seperated from each other but using the same infrastructure such as a shared switch or router. Only devices using the same VLAN ID will be able to see each other. For this to happen 4 bytes are added in front of the packet type field in the Ethernet frame pushing the original packet type field back by 4 bytes. The Ethernet frame will still be of a maximum length 1518 bytes including CRC what means that instead of a maximum of 1500 bytes that can be transferred the amount of bytes that can be transferred per Ethernet frame will shrink to 1496 bytes per packet. VLAN tagged packets are typically forwarded by any switch as they are as the type field has been simply replaced and in most cases only the destination MAC, source MAC and packet type is checked. In this case the packet is simply of an unknown protocol and will be forwarded by the switch. The picture below shows the structure of an Ethernet frame once without using a VLAN tag and once with using a VLAN tag being assigned to VLAN ID #2. Ethernet frame of max. 1518 bytes Dest MAC Src MAC Packet Type Packet Data 00:23:C7:FF:FF:FF 00:23:C7:FF:EE:EE IP Packet 0x0800 Max. 1500 bytes data + 4 bytes CRC Dest MAC Src MAC VLAN TAG TPI 00:23:C7:FF:FF:FF 00:23:C7:FF:EE:EE 0x8100 Packet Type Packet Data IP Packet 0x0800 Max. 1496 bytes data + 4 bytes CRC 16 bit TCI (12 bit VLAN ID) VLAN ID #2 0x0002 Ethernet frame of max. 1518 bytes UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 283 14.4 API functions Function IP_VLAN_AddInterface() Description Activates UPnP advertisement of the target in the network. Table 14.1: embOS/IP VLAN API function overview UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 284 CHAPTER 14 VLAN 14.4.1 IP_VLAN_AddInterface() Description Adds a VLAN interface. Prototype int IP_VLAN_AddInterface( unsigned HWIFace, U16 VLANId ); Parameter Parameter HWIFace VLANId Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces to be used as physical interface for the VLAN pseudo interface. [IN] 12 bit VLAN ID. Table 14.2: IP_VLAN_AddInterface() parameter list Return value Zero-based index of the added VALN interface. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 285 14.5 VLAN resource usage The ROM usage depends on the compiler options, the compiler version and the used CPU. The memory requirements of the VLAN modules presented in the tables below have been measured on an ARM7 and a Cortex-M3 system. Details about the further configuration can be found in the sections of the specific example. 14.5.1 ROM usage on an ARM7 system The following resource usage has been measured on an ARM7 system using IAR Embedded Workbench V6.30.6, Thumb mode, no interwork, size optimization. Addon embOS/IP VLAN ROM approximately 1.2Kbyte Table 14.3: VLAN ROM usage ARM7 14.5.2 ROM usage on a Cortex-M3 system The following resource usage has been measured on a Cortex-M3 system using IAR Embedded Workbench V6.30.6, size optimization. Addon embOS/IP VLAN ROM approximately 1.0Kbyte Table 14.4: VLAN ROM usage Cortex-M3 14.5.3 RAM usage Addon embOS/IP VLAN RAM approximately 16 bytes Table 14.5: VLAN RAM usage UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 286 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP CHAPTER 14 VLAN (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 287 Chapter 15 Network interface drivers embOS/IP has been designed to cooperate with any kind of hardware. To use specific hardware with embOS/IP, a so-called network interface driver for that hardware is required. The network interface driver consists of basic functions for accessing the hardware and a global table that holds pointers to these functions. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 288 CHAPTER 15 Network interface drivers 15.1 General information To use embOS/IP, a network interface driver matching the target hardware is required. The code size of a network interface driver depends on the hardware and is typically between 1 and 3 Kbytes. The driver handles both the MAC (media access control) unit as well as the PHY (Physical interface). We recommend using drivers written and tested by SEGGER. However, it is possible to write your own driver. This is explained in section Writing your own driver on page 318. The driver interface has been designed to allow support of internal and external Ethernet controllers (EMACs). It also allows to take full advantage of hardware features such as MAC address filtering and checksum computation in hardware. 15.1.1 MAC address filtering The stack passes a list of MAC addresses to the driver. The driver is responsible for making sure that all packets from all MAC addresses specified are passed to the stack. It can do so with "precise filtering" if the hardware has sufficient filters for the given number of MAC addresses. If more MAC addresses are passed to the driver than hardware filters are available, the driver can use a hash filter if available in hardware or switch to promiscuous mode. This is a very flexible solution which allows making best use of the hardware filtering capabilities on all known Ethernet controllers. It also allows simple implementations to simply switch to promiscuous mode. 15.1.2 Checksum computation in hardware When the interface is initialized, the stack queries the capabilities of the driver. If the hardware can compute IP, TCP, UDP, ICMP checksums, it can indicates this to the stack. In this case, the stack does not compute these checksums, improving throughput and reducing CPU load. 15.1.3 Ethernet CRC computation Every Ethernet packet includes a 32-bit trailing CRC. In most cases, the Ethernet controller is capable of computing the CRC. The drivers take advantage of this. The CRC is computed in the driver only if the hardware does not support CRC computation. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 289 15.2 Available network interface drivers Network interface drivers are optional components to embOS/IP. The following network interface drivers are available: Driver (Device) ATMEL AT91CAP9 ATMEL AT91RM9200 ATMEL AT91SAM7X ATMEL AT91SAM9260 ATMEL AT91SAM9263 ATMEL AT91SAMG20 ATMEL AT91SAMG45 ATMEL AT91SAM9XE ATMEL AVR32UC DAVICOM DM9000 FREESCALE ColdFire MCF5223x FREESCALE ColdFire MCF5329 NIOSII IFI GMACII EMAC NIOSII MaCo-Engineering EMAC NIOSII More than IP A2A bridge NXP LPC17xx NXP LPC2378 / LPC2478 NXP LPC32xx RENESAS H8S2472 RENESAS RX62N RENESAS SH7670 RENESAS (NEC) V850JGH3 SMSC LAN9115 / LAN9215 SMSC LAN9118 SMSC LAN91C111 ST STM32F107 (Connectivity Line) ST STM32F207 ST STR912 TI (LUMINARY) LM3S6965 TI (LUMINARY) LM3S9B90 Identifier IP_Driver_CAP9 IP_Driver_AT91RM9200 IP_Driver_SAM7X IP_Driver_SAM9260 IP_Driver_SAM9263 IP_Driver_SAM9G20 IP_Driver_SAMG45 IP_Driver_SAM9XE IP_Driver_AVR32UC IP_Driver_DM9000 IP_Driver_MCF5223x IP_Driver_MCF5329 IP_Driver_GMACII IP_Driver_NIOSII_MaCo IP_Driver_NIOSII_More10IP_A2A IP_Driver_LPC17xx IP_Driver_LPC24xx IP_Driver_LPC32xx IP_Driver_H8S2472 IP_Driver_RX62N IP_Driver_SH7670 IP_Driver_V850JGH3 IP_Driver_LAN9115 IP_Driver_LAN9118 IP_Driver_LAN91C111 IP_Driver_STM32F107 IP_Driver_STM32F207 IP_Driver_STR912 IP_Driver_LM3S6965 IP_Driver_LM3S9B90 Table 15.1: List of default network interface driver labels To add a driver to embOS/IP, IP_AddEtherInterface() should be called with the proper identifier before the TCP/IP stack starts any transmission. Refer to IP_AddEtherInterface() on page 49 for detailed information. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 290 CHAPTER 15 Network interface drivers 15.2.1 ATMEL AT91CAP9 Atmel's CAPTM is a microcontroller-based system-on-chip platform with a Metal Programmable (MP) Block that allows the designer to add custom logic. 15.2.1.1 Supported hardware The network interface driver for the AT91CAP9 can be used with every ATMEL AT91CAP9 target board. The driver has been tested on the following eval boards: Tested evaluation boards ATMEL CAP-DK Table 15.2: List of tested eval boards 15.2.1.2 Configuring the driver Adding the driver to embOS/IP To add the driver, use IP_AddEtherInterface() with the driver identifier IP_Driver_CAP9. This function must be called from IP_X_Config(). Refer to IP_AddEtherInterface() on page 49 and IP_X_Configure() on page 326 for more information. Example void IP_X_Config(void) { int mtu; IP_AssignMemory(_aPool, sizeof(_aPool)); IP_AddEtherInterface(&IP_Driver_CAP9); IP_SetHWAddr("\x00\x22\xC7\xFF\xFF\xFF"); // // // // Assigning memory Add Ethernet driver MAC addr: Needs to be unique for production units // // Add protocols to the stack // IP_TCP_Add(); IP_UDP_Add(); IP_ICMP_Add(); // // Set supported duplex modes // 10Mbit half duplex, 10Mbit full duplex, 100Mbit half duplex // and 100Mbit full duplex are supported. // IP_SetSupportedDuplexModes(0, IP_PHY_MODE_10_HALF | IP_PHY_MODE_10_FULL | IP_PHY_MODE_100_HALF | IP_PHY_MODE_100_FULL ); IP_NI_ConfigPHYMode (0, 1); // Use RMII mode // // Run-time configure buffers. // The default setup will do for most cases. // mtu = 1500; // 576 is minimum acc. to RFC, // 1500 is max. for Ethernet IP_SetMTU(0, mtu); // Maximum Transmission Unit is // 1500 for ethernet by default IP_AddBuffers(12, 256); // Small buffers. IP_AddBuffers(8, mtu + 40 + 16); // Big buffers. Size should be // mtu + 16 byte for ethernet header // (2 bytes type, 2*6 bytes MAC, // 2 bytes padding) IP_ConfTCPSpace(8 * (mtu-40), 8 * (mtu-40)); // // Use DHCP client or define IP address, subnet mask, // gateway address and DNS server according to the // requirements of your application. // IP_DHCPC_Activate(0, "TARGET", NULL, NULL); IP_SetWarnFilter(0xFFFFFFFF); // 0xFFFFFFFF: Do not filter: // Output all warnings. IP_SetLogFilter(IP_MTYPE_INIT | IP_MTYPE_LINK_CHANGE | IP_MTYPE_DHCP); } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 291 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 292 CHAPTER 15 Network interface drivers 15.2.1.3 Driver specific configuration functions Function Description Sets the number of Rx buffers. IP_NI_CAP9_ConfigNumRxBuffers() Table 15.3: embOS/IP CAP9 driver specific function overview 15.2.1.3.1 IP_NI_CAP9_ConfigNumRxBuffers Description Sets the number of Rx buffers of the driver. This function has to be called in the configuration phase. Prototype void IP_NI_CAP9_ConfigNumRxBuffers( U16 NumRxBuffers ); Parameter Parameter NumRxBuffers Description [IN] The number of Rx buffers. Table 15.4: IP_NI_CAP9_ConfigNumRxBuffers() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 293 15.2.1.4 Required BSP functions Function Description Initializes the network interface. BSP_ETH_Init() Table 15.5: embOS/IP driver specific function overview 15.2.1.4.1 BSP_ETH_Init() Description This function is called from the network interface driver. It initializes the network interface. This function should be used to enable the ports which are connected to the network hardware. It is called from the driver during the initialization process. Prototype void BSP_ETH_Init( unsigned Unit ); Parameter Parameter Unit Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces. Table 15.6: BSP_ETH_Init() parameter list Example /* Excerpt of BSP.c for the ATMEL AT91CAP9 CAP-DK */ /********************************************************************* * * BSP_ETH_Init() * * Function description * This function is called from the network interface driver. * It initializes the network interface. This function should be used * to enable the ports which are connected to the network hardware. * It is called from the driver during the initialization process. */ void BSP_ETH_Init(unsigned Unit) { unsigned PinsA; unsigned v; _PMC_PCER _EMAC_PORT_PPUDR = (1 << _ID_EMAC_PORT); = (1 << _EMAC_PORT_RXDV_BIT); // Enable clock for PIO // Disable RXDV pullup, // enter PHY normal mode // // Init PIO and perform a RESET of PHY since PHY // v = 0 | (1 << _EMAC_PORT_RXDV_BIT) ; _PIOB_PER = v; _PIOB_OER = v; _PIOB_CODR = 0 | (1 << _EMAC_PORT_RXDV_BIT) ; _PIOB_SODR = 0 | (1 << 0) // Isolate ; // // Perform hardware reset using RESET pin of MCU // AT91C_RSTC_RMR = 0xA5000000 | AT91C_RSTC_ERSTL & (1 << 8); AT91C_RSTC_RCR = 0xA5000000 | AT91C_RSTC_EXTRST; while ((AT91C_RSTC_RSR & AT91C_RSTC_NRSTL) == 0); // Wait until RESET timer has // expired (just a few ms) // // Init PIO Pins: EMAC is connected to specific lines of PIO // PinsA = (1uL << 11) // ETH_MDINTR | (1uL << 21) // ETXCK | (1uL << 22) // ERXDV | (1uL << 23) // ETX0 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 294 CHAPTER 15 _EMAC_PORT_ASR _EMAC_PORT_PDR = = | (1uL | (1uL | (1uL | (1uL | (1uL | (1uL | (1uL ; PinsA; PinsA; << << << << << << << 24) 25) 26) 27) 28) 29) 30) // // // // // // // Network interface drivers ETX1 ERX0 ERX1 ERXER ETXEN EMDC EMDIO // Select peripheral A use // Disable GPIO mode, // select peripheral function } 15.2.1.5 Additional information None. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 295 15.2.2 ATMEL AT91RM9200 The ATMEL AT919200 is based on the ARM920T processor. Its peripheral set includes USB Full Speed Host and Device Ports, 10/100 Base T Ethernet MAC, Multimedia Card Interface (MCI), three Synchronous Serial Controllers (SSC), four USARTs, Master/ Slave Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI), Timer Counters (TC) and Two Wire Interface (TWI), four 32-bit Parallel I/O Controllers and peripheral DMA channels. 15.2.2.1 Supported hardware The network interface driver for the AT91RM9200 can be used with every ATMEL AT91RM9200 target board. The driver has been tested on the following eval board(s): Tested evaluation boards ATMEL AT91RM9200-EK Table 15.7: List of tested eval boards 15.2.2.2 Configuring the driver Adding the driver to embOS/IP To add the driver, use IP_AddEtherInterface() with the driver identifier IP_Driver_RM9200. This function must be called from IP_X_Config(). Refer to IP_AddEtherInterface() on page 49 and IP_X_Configure() on page 326 for more information. Example void IP_X_Config(void) { int mtu; IP_AssignMemory(_aPool, sizeof(_aPool)); // Assigning memory IP_AddEtherInterface(&IP_Driver_AT91RM9200); // Add Ethernet driver IP_SetHWAddr("\x00\x22\xC7\xFF\xFF\xFF"); // MAC addr: Needs to be unique // for production units // // Add protocols to the stack // IP_TCP_Add(); IP_UDP_Add(); IP_ICMP_Add(); // // Set supported duplex modes // 10Mbit half duplex, 10Mbit full duplex, 100Mbit half duplex // and 100Mbit full duplex are supported. // IP_SetSupportedDuplexModes(0, IP_PHY_MODE_10_HALF | IP_PHY_MODE_10_FULL | IP_PHY_MODE_100_HALF | IP_PHY_MODE_100_FULL ); IP_NI_ConfigPHYMode (0, 1); // Use RMII mode // // Run-time configure buffers. // The default setup will do for most cases. // mtu = 1500; // 576 is minimum acc. to RFC, // 1500 is max. for Ethernet IP_SetMTU(0, mtu); // Maximum Transmission Unit is // 1500 for ethernet by default IP_AddBuffers(12, 256); // Small buffers. IP_AddBuffers(8, mtu + 40 + 16); // Big buffers. Size should be // mtu + 16 byte for ethernet header // (2 bytes type, 2*6 bytes MAC, // 2 bytes padding) IP_ConfTCPSpace(8 * (mtu-40), 8 * (mtu-40)); // // Use DHCP client or define IP address, subnet mask, // gateway address and DNS server according to the // requirements of your application. // IP_DHCPC_Activate(0, "TARGET", NULL, NULL); IP_SetWarnFilter(0xFFFFFFFF); // 0xFFFFFFFF: Do not filter: // Output all warnings. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 296 CHAPTER 15 Network interface drivers IP_SetLogFilter(IP_MTYPE_INIT | IP_MTYPE_LINK_CHANGE | IP_MTYPE_DHCP); } 15.2.2.3 Driver specific configuration functions Function Description IP_NI_AT91RM9200_ConfigNumRxBuffers() Sets the number of Rx buffers. Table 15.8: embOS/IP RM9200 driver specific function overview 15.2.2.3.1 IP_NI_AT91RM9200_ConfigNumRxBuffers Description Sets the number of Rx buffers of the driver. This function has to be called in the configuration phase. Prototype void IP_NI_AT91RM9200_ConfigNumRxBuffers( U16 NumRxBuffers ); Parameter Parameter NumRxBuffers Description [IN] The number of Rx buffers. Table 15.9: IP_NI_RM9200_ConfigNumRxBuffers() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 297 15.2.2.4 Required BSP functions Function Description Initializes the network interface. BSP_ETH_Init() Table 15.10: embOS/IP driver specific function overview 15.2.2.4.1 BSP_ETH_Init() Description This function is called from the network interface driver. It initializes the network interface. This function should be used to enable the ports which are connected to the network hardware. It is called from the driver during the initialization process. Prototype void BSP_ETH_Init( unsigned Unit ); Parameter Parameter Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces. Unit Table 15.11: BSP_ETH_Init() parameter list Example /* Excerpt of BSP.c for the ATMEL AT91RM9200-EK */ #define #define #define #define #define #define #define #define #define #define #define #define #define #define #define #define _PIOA_BASE_ADDR _PMC_BASE_ADDR _PIO_PUDR_OFF _PIO_PUER_OFF _PIO_ASR_OFF _PIO_BSR_OFF _PMC _PMC_PCER _PMC_PCDR _PIOA_ASR _PIOA_BSR _PIOA_PUDR _PIOA_PUER _PIOA_ID _PIOB_ID _EMAC_ID (0xFFFFF400UL) (0xFFFFFC00UL) (0x60) (0x64) (0x70) (0x74) (*(volatile unsigned int*)(_PMC_BASE_ADDR)) (*(volatile unsigned int*)(_PMC_BASE_ADDR + 0x10)) (*(volatile unsigned int*)(_PMC_BASE_ADDR + 0x14)) (*(volatile unsigned int*)(_PIOA_BASE_ADDR + _PIO_ASR_OFF)) (*(volatile unsigned int*)(_PIOA_BASE_ADDR + _PIO_BSR_OFF)) (*(volatile unsigned int*)(_PIOA_BASE_ADDR + _PIO_PUDR_OFF)) (*(volatile unsigned int*)(_PIOA_BASE_ADDR + _PIO_PUER_OFF)) (2) // Parallel IO Controller A (3) // Parallel IO Controller B (24) // EMAC /********************************************************************* * * BSP_ETH_Init() */ void BSP_ETH_Init(unsigned Unit) { unsigned int Pins; // // Initialize peripheral clock // _PMC_PCER = (1 << _EMAC_ID); _PMC_PCER = (1 << _PIOA_ID); _PIOA_PUDR = (1 << 11); _PIOA_PUER = (1 << #ifdef RMII Pins = ((unsigned | ((unsigned | ((unsigned | ((unsigned | ((unsigned | ((unsigned | ((unsigned | ((unsigned | ((unsigned | ((unsigned ; #else 16); int) int) int) int) int) int) int) int) int) int) (1 (1 (1 (1 (1 (1 (1 (1 (1 (1 << << << << << << << << << << UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP // // // // // Ensure the clock for EMAC is enabled Ensure the clock for PIOA is enabled Disable RXDV pullup, enter PHY normal mode Note: the PHY has an internal pull-down Enable Pull-Up on EMDIO pin 7)) 8)) 9)) 10)) 11)) 12)) 13)) 14)) 15)) 16)) (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 298 CHAPTER 15 #error "MII-mode #endif _PIOA_ASR = _PIOA_BSR = _PIOA_PDR = } Network interface drivers not supported by AT91RM9200-EK" Pins; 0; Pins; // Select peripheral A use of the associated pins // Select peripheral B, no peripheral B pins used // Set peripheral control of the associated pins 15.2.2.5 Additional information None. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 299 15.2.3 ATMEL AT91SAM7X The ATMEL AT91SAM7X's are flash microcontrollers with integrated Ethernet, USB and CAN interfaces, based on the 32-bit ARM7TDMI RISC processor. 15.2.3.1 Supported hardware The network interface driver for the AT91SAM7X can be used with every ATMEL AT91SAM7X target board. The driver has been tested on the following eval boards: Tested evaluation boards ATMEL AT91SAM7X-EK Olimex SAM7-EX256 Table 15.12: List of tested eval boards 15.2.3.2 Configuring the driver Adding the driver to embOS/IP To add the driver, use IP_AddEtherInterface() with the driver identifier IP_Driver_SAM7X. This function has to be called from IP_X_Config(). Refer to IP_AddEtherInterface() on page 49 and IP_X_Configure() on page 326 for more information. Example void IP_X_Config(void) { IP_AssignMemory(_aPool, sizeof(_aPool)); IP_AddEtherInterface(&IP_Driver_SAM7X); IP_SetHWAddr("\x00\x22\xC7\xFF\xFF\xFF"); // // // // Assigning memory Add Ethernet driver MAC addr: Needs to be unique for production units // // Add protocols to the stack // IP_TCP_Add(); IP_UDP_Add(); IP_ICMP_Add(); // // Set supported duplex modes // 10Mbit half duplex, 10Mbit full duplex, 100Mbit half duplex // and 100Mbit full duplex are supported. // IP_SetSupportedDuplexModes(0, IP_PHY_MODE_10_HALF | IP_PHY_MODE_10_FULL | IP_PHY_MODE_100_HALF | IP_PHY_MODE_100_FULL ); // // Run-time configure buffers. // The default setup will do for most cases. // mtu = 1500; // 576 is minimum acc. to RFC, // 1500 is max. for Ethernet IP_SetMTU(0, mtu); // Maximum Transmission Unit is // 1500 for ethernet by default IP_AddBuffers(12, 256); // Small buffers. IP_AddBuffers(6, mtu + 40 + 16); // Big buffers. Size should be // mtu + 16 byte for ethernet header // (2 bytes type, 2*6 bytes MAC, // 2 bytes padding) IP_ConfTCPSpace(3 * (mtu-40), 3 * (mtu-40)); IP_DHCPC_Activate(0, "TARGET", NULL, NULL); IP_SetWarnFilter(0xFFFFFFFF); // 0xFFFFFFFF: Do not filter: // Output all warnings. IP_SetLogFilter(IP_MTYPE_INIT | IP_MTYPE_LINK_CHANGE | IP_MTYPE_DHCP); } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 300 CHAPTER 15 Network interface drivers 15.2.3.3 Driver specific configuration functions Function Description Sets the number of Rx buffers. IP_NI_SAM7X_ConfigNumRxBuffers() Table 15.13: embOS/IP SAM7X driver specific function overview 15.2.3.3.1 IP_NI_SAM7X_ConfigNumRxBuffers() Description Sets the number of Rx buffers of the driver. This function has to be called in the configuration phase. Prototype void IP_NI_SAM7X_ConfigNumRxBuffers( U16 NumRxBuffers ); Parameter Parameter NumRxBuffers Description [IN] The number of Rx buffers. Table 15.14: IP_NI_SAM7X_ConfigNumRxBuffers() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 301 15.2.3.4 Required BSP functions Function Description Initializes the network interface. BSP_ETH_Init() Table 15.15: embOS/IP driver specific function overview 15.2.3.4.1 BSP_ETH_Init() Description This function is called from the network interface driver. It initializes the network interface. This function should be used to enable the ports which are connected to the network hardware. It is called from the driver during the initialization process. Prototype void BSP_ETH_Init( unsigned Unit ); Parameter Parameter Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces. Unit Table 15.16: BSP_ETH_Init() parameter list Example /* Excerpt from implementation for ATMEL AT91SAM7X-EK */ #define #define #define #define #define #define #define #define #define #define #define #define #define #define AT91C_PMC_PCER (*(volatile AT91C_PIOB_PPUDR (*(volatile AT91C_PIOB_PER (*(volatile AT91C_PIOB_OER (*(volatile AT91C_PIOB_CODR (*(volatile AT91C_PIOB_SODR (*(volatile AT91C_PIOB_ODR (*(volatile AT91C_PIOB_PDR (*(volatile AT91C_RSTC_RMR (*(volatile AT91C_PIOB_ASR (*(volatile AT91C_RSTC_RCR (*(volatile AT91C_RSTC_ERSTL AT91C_RSTC_EXTRST AT91C_RSTC_NRSTL unsigned*) unsigned*) unsigned*) unsigned*) unsigned*) unsigned*) unsigned*) unsigned*) unsigned*) unsigned*) unsigned*) 0xFFFFFC10) 0xFFFFF660) 0xFFFFF600) 0xFFFFF610) 0xFFFFF634) 0xFFFFF630) 0xFFFFF614) 0xFFFFF604) 0xFFFFFD08) 0xFFFFF670) 0xFFFFFD00) (0xF << 8) (0x1 << 3) (1UL << 16) void BSP_ETH_Init(unsigned Unit) { unsigned v; AT91C_PMC_PCER AT91C_PIOB_PPUDR = (1 << _PIOB_ID); // Enable clock for PIOB = 1UL << 15; // Disable RXDV pullup, // enter PHY normal mode = 1UL << 16; AT91C_PIOB_PPUDR // // Init PIO and perform a RESET of PHY // v = 0 | (1 << | (1 << | (1 << | (1 << ; AT91C_PIOB_PER AT91C_PIOB_OER AT91C_PIOB_CODR UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP = = = | | since PHY 0) 15) 16) 18) v; // Entire lower 19 bits enabled v; 0 (1 << 7) // 0: node mode, 1: repeater mode (1 << 15) // 0: Normal mode, 1: test mode (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 302 CHAPTER 15 | (1 << 16) | (1 << 18) ; AT91C_PIOB_SODR = 0 | (1 << 0) ; Network interface drivers // 0: MII // 0: Power down // Isolate // // Perform hardware reset using RESET pin of MCU // AT91C_RSTC_RMR = 0xA5000000 | AT91C_RSTC_ERSTL & (1 << 8); AT91C_RSTC_RCR = 0xA5000000 | AT91C_RSTC_EXTRST; while ((AT91C_RSTC_RSR & AT91C_RSTC_NRSTL) == 0); // Wait until RESET timer has // expired // // Switch to peripheral functions // v = 0x3FFFF; // Lower 18 bits are used for the peripheral AT91C_PIOB_ODR = v; // Entire lower 18 bits disabled AT91C_PIOB_ASR = v; // Select peripheral A use AT91C_PIOB_PDR = v; // Disable GPIO mode, select peripheral } 15.2.3.5 Additional information None. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 303 15.2.4 ATMEL AT91SAM9260 The ATMEL AT91SAM9260 is based on the ARM926EJ-STM processor. Its peripheral set includes USB Full Speed Host and Device interfaces, a 10/100 Base T Ethernet MAC, Image Sensor Interface, Multimedia Card Interface (MCI), Synchronous Serial Controllers (SSC), USARTs, Master/Slave Serial Peripheral Interfaces (SPI), a threechannel 16-bit Timer Counter (TC), a Two Wire Interface (TWI) and four-channel 10bit ADC. 15.2.4.1 Supported hardware The network interface driver for the AT91SAM9260 can be used with every ATMEL AT91SAM9260 target board. The driver has been tested on the following eval boards: Tested evaluation boards ATMEL AT91SAM9260 Table 15.17: List of tested eval boards 15.2.4.2 Configuring the driver Adding the driver to embOS/IP To add the driver, use IP_AddEtherInterface() with the driver identifier IP_Driver_SAM9260. This function must be called from IP_X_Config(). Refer to IP_AddEtherInterface() on page 49 and IP_X_Configure() on page 326 for more information. Example void IP_X_Config(void) { IP_AssignMemory(_aPool, sizeof(_aPool)); IP_AddEtherInterface(&IP_Driver_SAM9260); IP_SetHWAddr("\x00\x22\xC7\xFF\xFF\xFF"); // // // // Assigning memory Add Ethernet driver MAC addr: Needs to be unique for production units IP_DHCPC_Activate(0, "TARGET", NULL, NULL); // // Add protocols to the stack // IP_TCP_Add(); IP_UDP_Add(); IP_ICMP_Add(); // // Run-time configure buffers. // The default setup will do for most cases. // IP_AddBuffers(50, 256); // IP_AddBuffers(50, 1536); // // IP_ConfTCPSpace(16 * 1024, 16 * 1024); IP_SetWarnFilter(0xFFFFFFFF); // // IP_SetLogFilter(IP_MTYPE_INIT | IP_MTYPE_LINK_CHANGE | IP_MTYPE_DHCP); Small buffers. Big buffers. Size should be 1536 to allow a full ether packet to fit. 0xFFFFFFFF: Do not filter: Output all warnings. } 15.2.4.3 Driver specific configuration functions Function Description Sets the number of Rx buffers. IP_NI_SAM9260_ConfigNumRxBuffers() Table 15.18: embOS/IP SAM9260 driver specific function overview 15.2.4.3.1 IP_NI_SAM9260_ConfigNumRxBuffers Description Sets the number of Rx buffers of the driver. This function has to be called in the configuration phase. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 304 CHAPTER 15 Network interface drivers Prototype void IP_NI_SAM9260_ConfigNumRxBuffers( U16 NumRxBuffers ); Parameter Parameter NumRxBuffers Description [IN] The number of Rx buffers. Table 15.19: IP_NI_SAM9260_ConfigNumRxBuffers() parameter list 15.2.4.4 Required BSP functions Function Description Initializes the network interface. BSP_ETH_Init() Table 15.20: embOS/IP driver specific function overview 15.2.4.4.1 BSP_ETH_Init() Description This function is called from the network interface driver. It initializes the network interface. This function should be used to enable the ports which are connected to the network hardware. It is called from the driver during the initialization process. Prototype void BSP_ETH_Init( unsigned Unit ); Parameter Parameter Unit Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces. Table 15.21: BSP_ETH_Init() parameter list Example /********************************************************************* * * BSP_ETH_Init() * * Function description * This function is called from the network interface driver. * It initializes the network interface. This function should be used * to enable the ports which are connected to the network hardware. * It is called from the driver during the initialization process. * * Note: * (1) If your MAC is connected to the PHY via Media Independent * Interface (MII) change the macro _USE_RMII and call * IP_NI_ConfigPHYMode() from within IP_X_Config() * to change the default of driver. * */ void BSP_ETH_Init(unsigned Unit) { unsigned PinsA; unsigned PinsB; PMC_PCER = (1 << ID_EMAC_PORT); // Enable clock for PIO EMAC_PORT_PPUDR = (1 << EMAC_PORT_RXDV_BIT); // Disable RXDV pullup, // enter PHY normal mode #if _USE_RMII EMAC_PORT_PPUER = (1 << EMAC_PORT_RMII_BIT); // Enable Pullup => Switch to RMII. #else EMAC_PORT_PPUDR = (1 << EMAC_PORT_RMII_BIT); // Disable Pullup => Switch to MII. #endif // // Power up PHY, may not be required, if set as hardwired option on target // #ifdef EMAC_PORT_PWR_PHY_BIT EMAC_PORT_PER = (1 << EMAC_PORT_PWR_PHY_BIT); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 305 EMAC_PORT_OER = (1 << EMAC_PORT_PWR_PHY_BIT); EMAC_PORT_CODR = (1 << EMAC_PORT_PWR_PHY_BIT); #endif // // Init PIO Pins: EMAC is connected to specific lines of PIO // PinsA = (1uL << 12) | (1uL << 13) | (1uL << 14) | (1uL << 15) | (1uL << 16) | (1uL << 17) | (1uL << 18) | (1uL << 19) | (1uL << 20) | (1uL << 21) ; PinsB = (1uL << 10) | (1uL << 11) | (1uL << 22) | (1uL << 25) | (1uL << 26) | (1uL << 27) | (1uL << 28) | (1uL << 29) ; EMAC_PORT_ASR = PinsA; // Select peripheral A use EMAC_PORT_BSR = PinsB; // Select peripheral B use EMAC_PORT_PDR = PinsA | PinsB; // Disable GPIO mode, select peripheral function // // Initialize priority of BUS MATRIX. EMAC needs highest priority for SDRAM access // MATRIX_SCFG3 = 0x01160030; // Assign EMAC as default master, activate priority arbitration, increase cycles MATRIX_PRAS3 = 0x00320000; // Set Priority of EMAC to 3 (highest value) } 15.2.4.5 Additional information None. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 306 CHAPTER 15 Network interface drivers 15.2.5 DAVICOM DM9000/DM9000A The Davicom DM9000 is a fully integrated single chip Fast Ethernet MAC controller with a generic processor interface, a 10/100M PHY and SRAM. 15.2.5.1 Supported hardware The network interface driver for the Davicom DM9000 can be used with every target board which complies with the following: * * * Davicom DM9000 is presented DM 9000 is connected to the data/address bus; data bus is 16-bits wide INT pin connected to CPU in a way which allows generating interrupts The driver has been tested on the following eval boards: Tested evaluation boards ATMEL AT91SAM9261-EK Table 15.22: List of tested eval boards 15.2.5.2 Configuring the driver Adding the driver to embOS/IP To add the driver, use IP_AddEtherInterface() with the driver identifier IP_Driver_DM9000. This function must be called from within IP_X_Config(). Refer to IP_AddEtherInterface() on page 49 and IP_X_Configure() on page 326 for more information. Example void IP_X_Config(void) { IP_AssignMemory(_aPool, sizeof(_aPool)); // Assigning memory IP_AddEtherInterface(&IP_Driver_DM9000); // Add Ethernet driver IP_NI_DM9000_ConfigAddr(0, (void*) (0x30000000), (void*) (0x30000000 + 0x04)); IP_NI_ConfigPoll(0); // No ISR routine IP_SetHWAddr("\x00\x22\x33\x44\x55\x66"); // MAC addr: Needs to be unique IP_DHCPC_Activate(0, "TARGET", NULL, NULL); // // Add protocols to the stack // IP_TCP_Add(); IP_UDP_Add(); IP_ICMP_Add(); // // Run-time configure buffers. The default setup will do for most cases. // IP_AddBuffers(12, 256); // Small buffers. IP_AddBuffers(12, 1536); // Big buffers. Size should be 1536 to // allow a full ether packet to fit. IP_ConfTCPSpace(6 * 1024, 4 * 1024); IP_SetWarnFilter(0xFFFFFFFF); // 0xFFFFFFFF: Do not filter: // Output all warnings. IP_SetLogFilter(IP_MTYPE_INIT | IP_MTYPE_LINK_CHANGE | IP_MTYPE_DHCP ); } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 307 15.2.5.3 Driver-specific configuration functions Function Description Sets the base address for commands and data register. Interrupt service routine for the network interface. IP_NI_DM9000_ConfigAddr() IP_NI_DM9000_ISR_Handler() Table 15.23: embOS/IP DM9000 driver-specific function overview 15.2.5.3.1 IP_NI_DM9000_ConfigAddr() Description Sets the base address (for command) and data address. Prototype void IP_NI_DM9000_ConfigAddr( unsigned Unit, void * pBase, void * pValue ); Parameter Parameter Unit pBase pValue Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces. [IN] Pointer to the control register of the MAC. [IN] Pointer to the data register of the MAC. Table 15.24: IP_NI_DM9000_ConfigAddr() parameter list Additional information This function must be called from within IP_X_Config. Refer to IP_X_Configure() on page 326 for detailed information. 15.2.5.3.2 IP_NI_DM9000_ISR_Handler() Description This is the interrupt service routine for the network interface (EMAC). It handles all interrupts (Rx, Tx, Error). Prototype void IP_NI_DM9000_ISR_Handler( unsigned Unit ); Parameter Parameter Unit Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces. Table 15.25: IP_NI_DM9000_ISR_Handler() parameter list UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 308 CHAPTER 15 Network interface drivers 15.2.5.4 Required BSP functions Function Description Initializes the network interface. BSP_ETH_Init() Table 15.26: embOS/IP driver specific function overview 15.2.5.4.1 BSP_ETH_Init() Description This function is called from the network interface driver. It initializes the network interface. This function should be used to enable the ports which are connected to the network hardware. It is called from the driver during the initialization process. Prototype void BSP_ETH_Init( unsigned Unit ); 15.2.5.5 Additinal information None. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 309 15.2.6 FREESCALE ColdFire MCF5329 15.2.6.1 Supported hardware The network interface driver for the ColdFire MCF5329 MCU can be used with every target board. The driver has been tested on the following eval boards: Tested evaluation boards LOGICPD ZOOM COLDFIRE SDK with MCF5329 Fire Engine Table 15.27: List of tested eval boards 15.2.6.2 Configuring the driver Adding the driver to embOS/IP To add the driver, use IP_AddEtherInterface() with the driver identifier IP_Driver_MCF5329. This function must be called from IP_X_Config(). Refer to IP_AddEtherInterface() on page 49 and IP_X_Configure() on page 326 for more information. Example /* Sample implementation taken from the configuration for the ColdFire MCF5329 */ #define ALLOC_SIZE U32 _aPool[ALLOC_SIZE / 4]; 0xA000 // Size of memory dedicated // to the stack in bytes // This is the memory area used // by the stack. /********************************************************************* * * IP_X_Config */ void IP_X_Config(void) { IP_AssignMemory(_aPool, sizeof(_aPool)); // Assigning memory IP_AddEtherInterface(&IP_Driver_MCF5329); // Add ethernet driver IP_SetHWAddr((const unsigned char *)"\x00\x22\xC7\xFF\xFF\xFF"); // // Use DHCP client or define IP address, subnet mask, // gateway address and DNS server according to the // requirements of your application. // IP_DHCPC_Activate(0, "TARGET", NULL, NULL); // IP_SetAddrMask(0xC0A805E6, 0xFFFF0000); // Assign IP addr. and subnet mask // IP_SetGWAddr(0, 0xC0A80201); // Set gateway address // IP_DNS_SetServer(0xCC98B84C); // Set DNS server address, // for example 204.152.184.76 // // Add protocols to the stack // IP_TCP_Add(); IP_UDP_Add(); IP_ICMP_Add(); // // Run-time configure buffers. // The default setup will do for most cases. // IP_AddBuffers(12, 256); // Small buffers. IP_AddBuffers(10, 1536); // Big buffers. IP_ConfTCPSpace(4 * 1024, 4 * 1024); // Define the TCP Tx and Rx window size // // Define log and warn filter // IP_SetWarnFilter(0xFFFFFFFF); IP_SetLogFilter(IP_MTYPE_INIT UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 310 CHAPTER 15 Network interface drivers | IP_MTYPE_LINK_CHANGE | IP_MTYPE_DHCP ); } 15.2.6.3 Driver-specific configuration functions None. 15.2.6.4 Required BSP functions None. 15.2.6.5 Additional information None. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 311 Parameter Parameter Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces. Unit Table 15.28: BSP_ETH_Init() parameter list Example /* Excerpt from implementation for the ATMEL AT91SAM9261-EK */ #define #define #define #define #define #define #define _PIOC_ID _PMC_PCER _PIOC_PER _PIOC_ODR _PIOC_OER _PIOC_SODR _PIOC_CODR (4) (*(volatile (*(volatile (*(volatile (*(volatile (*(volatile (*(volatile unsigned unsigned unsigned unsigned unsigned unsigned int*) int*) int*) int*) int*) int*) 0xFFFFF810) 0xFFFFFC00) 0xFFFFFC14) 0xFFFFFC10) 0xFFFFFC30) 0xFFFFFC34) /********************************************************************* * * BSP_ETH_Init() */ void BSP_ETH_Init(unsigned Unit) { int i; _PMC_PCER |= (1 << _PIOC_ID); // Enable peripheral clock _PIOC_PER = (1 << 10) | (1 << 11); // Enable Ports for RESET and Interrupt _PIOC_OER = (1 << 10); // Switch RESET to output mode _PIOC_ODR = (1 << 11); // Switch Interrupt to output mode // // Activate & deactivate RESET of Ethernet controller. // We do this in a loop to allow sufficient time for Controller to get out of RESET // for (i = 0; i < 1000; i++) { _PIOC_SODR = (1 << 10); // Activate RESET } for (i = 0; i < 1000; i++) { _PIOC_CODR = (1 << 10); // Deactivate RESET } } 15.2.6.6 Additional information None. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 312 CHAPTER 15 Network interface drivers 15.2.7 NXP LPC17xx The NXP LPC17xx MCUs are flash microcontrollers with integrated Ethernet, USB and CAN interfaces, based on the 32-bit Cortex-M3 processor. 15.2.7.1 Supported hardware The network interface driver for the NXP 17xx can be used with every NXP LPC17xx target board. The driver has been tested on the following eval boards: Tested evaluation boards KEIL MCB1760 IAR LPC1768-SK EmbeddedArtists LPC1788 Table 15.29: List of tested eval boards 15.2.7.2 Configuring the driver Adding the driver to embOS/IP To add the driver, use IP_AddEtherInterface() with the driver identifier IP_Driver_LPC24xx. This function must be called from IP_X_Config(). Refer to IP_AddEtherInterface() on page 49 and IP_X_Configure() on page 326 for more information. Example /* Sample implementation taken from the configuration for the NXP LPC2468 */ /********************************************************************* * * IP_X_Config * * Function description * This function is called by the IP stack during IP_Init(). */ void IP_X_Config(void) { IP_AssignMemory(_aPool, sizeof(_aPool)); // Assigning memory IP_AddEtherInterface(&IP_Driver_LPC17xx); // Add ethernet driver IP_SetHWAddr("\x00\x22\x33\x44\x55\x66"); // MAC addr: Needs to be unique // for production units IP_DHCPC_Activate(0, "TARGET", NULL, NULL); // // Add protocols to the stack // IP_TCP_Add(); IP_UDP_Add(); IP_ICMP_Add(); // // Run-time configure buffers. // The default setup will do for most cases. // IP_AddBuffers(6, 256); // Small buffers. IP_AddBuffers(8, 1536); // Big buffers. Size should be 1536 // to allow a full ether packet to fit. IP_ConfTCPSpace(6 * 1024, 6 * 1024); IP_SetWarnFilter(0xFFFFFFFF); // Do not filter: Output all warnings. IP_SetLogFilter(IP_MTYPE_INIT | IP_MTYPE_LINK_CHANGE ); } 15.2.7.3 Driver-specific configuration functions None. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 313 15.2.7.4 Required BSP functions Function Description Initializes the network interface. BSP_ETH_Init() Table 15.30: embOS/IP driver specific function overview 15.2.7.4.1 BSP_ETH_Init() Description This function is called from the network interface driver. It initializes the network interface. This function should be used to enable the ports which are connected to the network hardware. It is called from the driver during the initialization process. Prototype void BSP_ETH_Init( unsigned Unit ); Parameter Parameter Unit Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces. Table 15.31: BSP_ETH_Init() parameter list Example /* Sample implementation for NXP LPC2468 */ #define PINSEL2 #define PINSEL3 *(volatile unsigned long *)(0xE002C008) *(volatile unsigned long *)(0xE002C00C) /********************************************************************* * * ETH_Init */ void BSP_ETH_Init(unsigned Unit) { /*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------* write to PINSEL2/3 to select the PHY functions on P1[17:0] *-----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ /* P1.6, ENET-TX_CLK, has to be set for EMAC to address a BUG in the rev"xx-X" or "xx-Y" silicon(see errata). On the new rev.(xxAY, released on 06/22/2007), P1.6 should NOT be set. */ if (MAC_MODULEID == 0x39022000) { // Older chip ? PINSEL2 = 0x50151105; /* Selects P1[0,1,4,6,8,9,10,14,15] */ } else { PINSEL2 = 0x50150105; /* Selects P1[0,1,4,8,9,10,14,15] */ } PINSEL3 = (PINSEL3 & ~0x0000000f) | 0x5; } 15.2.7.5 Additional information None. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 314 CHAPTER 15 Network interface drivers 15.2.8 NXP LPC23xx / 24xx The NXP LPC23xx and LPC24xx MCU families are flash microcontrollers with integrated Ethernet, USB and CAN interfaces, based on the 32-bit ARM7TDMI-S RISC processor. 15.2.8.1 Supported hardware The network interface driver for the NXP LPC23xx and LPC24xx MCUs can be used with every NXP LPC23xx/LPC24xx target board. The driver has been tested on the following eval boards: Tested evaluation boards KEIL MCB2300 IAR LPC2468 V1.0 EmbeddedArtists LPC2468 Table 15.32: List of tested eval boards 15.2.8.2 Configuring the driver Adding the driver to embOS/IP To add the driver, use IP_AddEtherInterface() with the driver identifier IP_Driver_LPC24xx. This function must be called from IP_X_Config(). Refer to IP_AddEtherInterface() on page 49 and IP_X_Configure() on page 326 for more information. Example /* Sample implementation taken from the configuration for the NXP LPC2468 */ /********************************************************************* * * IP_X_Config * * Function description * This function is called by the IP stack during IP_Init(). */ void IP_X_Config(void) { IP_AssignMemory(_aPool, sizeof(_aPool)); // Assigning memory IP_AddEtherInterface(&IP_Driver_LPC24xx); // Add ethernet driver IP_SetHWAddr("\x00\x22\x33\x44\x55\x66"); // MAC addr: Needs to be unique // for production units IP_DHCPC_Activate(0, "TARGET", NULL, NULL); // // Add protocols to the stack // IP_TCP_Add(); IP_UDP_Add(); IP_ICMP_Add(); // // Run-time configure buffers. // The default setup will do for most cases. // IP_AddBuffers(6, 256); // Small buffers. IP_AddBuffers(8, 1536); // Big buffers. Size should be 1536 // to allow a full ether packet to fit. IP_ConfTCPSpace(6 * 1024, 6 * 1024); IP_SetWarnFilter(0xFFFFFFFF); // Do not filter: Output all warnings. IP_SetLogFilter(IP_MTYPE_INIT | IP_MTYPE_LINK_CHANGE ); } UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 315 15.2.8.3 Driver-specific configuration functions None. 15.2.8.4 Required BSP functions Function Description Initializes the network interface. BSP_ETH_Init() Table 15.33: embOS/IP driver specific function overview 15.2.8.4.1 BSP_ETH_Init() Description This function is called from the network interface driver. It initializes the network interface. This function should be used to enable the ports which are connected to the network hardware. It is called from the driver during the initialization process. Prototype void BSP_ETH_Init( unsigned Unit ); Parameter Parameter Unit Description [IN] Zero-based index of available network interfaces. Table 15.34: BSP_ETH_Init() parameter list Example /* Sample implementation for NXP LPC2468 */ #define PINSEL2 #define PINSEL3 *(volatile unsigned long *)(0xE002C008) *(volatile unsigned long *)(0xE002C00C) /********************************************************************* * * ETH_Init */ void BSP_ETH_Init(unsigned Unit) { /*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------* write to PINSEL2/3 to select the PHY functions on P1[17:0] *-----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ /* P1.6, ENET-TX_CLK, has to be set for EMAC to address a BUG in the rev"xx-X" or "xx-Y" silicon(see errata). On the new rev.(xxAY, released on 06/22/2007), P1.6 should NOT be set. */ if (MAC_MODULEID == 0x39022000) { // Older chip ? PINSEL2 = 0x50151105; /* Selects P1[0,1,4,6,8,9,10,14,15] */ } else { PINSEL2 = 0x50150105; /* Selects P1[0,1,4,8,9,10,14,15] */ } PINSEL3 = (PINSEL3 & ~0x0000000f) | 0x5; } 15.2.8.5 Additional information None. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 316 CHAPTER 15 Network interface drivers 15.2.9 ST STR912 The ST STR912 is based on the ARM966E-STM processor. It is a flash microcontroller with integrated Ethernet, USB and CAN interfaces, AC Motor Control, 4 Timers, ADC, RTC, and DMA. 15.2.9.1 Supported hardware The network interface driver for the STR912 can be used with every target ST STR912 target board. The driver has been tested on the following eval boards: Tested evaluation boards IAR STR912FA development board Table 15.35: List of tested eval boards 15.2.9.2 Configuring the driver Adding the driver to embOS/IP To add the driver, use IP_AddEtherInterface() with the driver identifier IP_Driver_STR912. This function must be called from IP_X_Config(). Refer to IP_AddEtherInterface() on page 49 and IP_X_Configure() on page 326 for more information. Example /* Sample implementation taken from the configuration for the ST STR912 */ void IP_X_Config(void) { IP_AssignMemory(_aPool, sizeof(_aPool)); IP_AddEtherInterface(&IP_Driver_STR912); IP_SetHWAddr("\x00\x22\x33\x44\x55\x66"); // // // // IP_DHCPC_Activate(0, "TARGET", NULL, NULL); // // Add protocols to the stack // IP_TCP_Add(); IP_UDP_Add(); IP_ICMP_Add(); // // Run-time configure buffers. // The default setup will do for most cases. // IP_AddBuffers(20, 256); // IP_AddBuffers(12, 1536); // // IP_ConfTCPSpace(8 * 1024, 8 * 1024); IP_SetWarnFilter(0xFFFFFFFF); // // IP_SetLogFilter(IP_MTYPE_INIT | IP_MTYPE_LINK_CHANGE | IP_MTYPE_DHCP); Assigning memory Add Ethernet driver MAC addr: Needs to be unique for production units Small buffers. Big buffers. Size should be 1536 to allow a full ether packet to fit. 0xFFFFFFFF: Do not filter: Output all warnings. } 15.2.9.3 Driver-specific configuration functions None. 15.2.9.4 Required BSP functions None. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 317 15.2.9.5 Additional information None. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 318 CHAPTER 15 Network interface drivers 15.3 Writing your own driver If you are going to use embOS/IP with your own hardware, you may have to write your own network interface driver. This section describes which functions are required and how to integrate your own network interface driver into embOS/IP. Note: We strongly recommend contacting SEGGER if you need to have a driver for a particular piece of hardware which is not yet supported. Writing a driver is a difficult task which requires a thorough understanding of Ethernet, MAC, and PHY. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 319 15.3.1 Network interface driver structure embOS/IP uses a simple structure with function pointers to call the appropriate driver function for a device. Use the supplied template IP_NI_Template.c for the implementation. Device Driver Structure pfInit() pfTimer() pfSendPackedIfTxIdle() pfGetPacketSize() pfReadPacket() pfControl() Data structure typedef struct IP_HW_DRIVER { int (*pfInit) ( unsigned int (*pfSendPacket) ( unsigned int (*pfGetPacketSize) ( unsigned int (*pfReadPacket) ( unsigned void (*pfTimer) ( unsigned int (*pfControl) ( unsigned } IP_HW_DRIVER; Unit ); Unit ); Unit ); Unit, U8 * pDest, unsigned NumBytes ); Unit ); Unit, int Cmd, void * p ); Elements of IP_HW_DRIVER Element pfInit pfSendPacket pfGetPacketSize pfReadPacket pfTimer pfControl Meaning Pointer to the initialization function. Pointer to the send packet function. Pointer to the get packet size function. Pointer to the read packet function. Optional: Pointer to the timer function. The routine is called from the stack periodically. Pointer to the control function. Table 15.36: IP_HW_DRIVER - List of structure member variables Example /* Sample implementation taken from the driver for the ATMEL AT91SAM7X */ /********************************************************************* * * Driver API Table * ********************************************************************** */ const IP_HW_DRIVER IP_Driver_SAM7X = { _Init, _SendPacketIfTxIdle, _GetPacketSize, _ReadPacket, _Timer, _Control }; UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 320 CHAPTER 15 Network interface drivers 15.3.2 Device driver functions This section provides descriptions of the network interface driver functions required by embOS/IP. Note that the names used for these functions are not really relevant for embOS/IP because the stack accesses them through a structure of function pointers. Function pfControl() pfInit() pfGetPacketSize() pfReadPacket() pfSendPacketIfTxIdle() pfTimer() Description This function is used to implement additional driver specific control functions. It can be empty. General initialization function of the driver. Reads buffer descriptors to find out if a packet has been received. Reads the first packet in the buffer. Send the next packet in the send queue if transmitter is idle. Timer function called by the networking task, IP_Task(), once per second. Table 15.37: embOS/IP network interface driver functions UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 321 15.3.3 Driver template The driver template IP_NI_Template.c is supplied in the folder Sample\Driver\Template\. Example /********************************************************************* * SEGGER MICROCONTROLLER SYSTEME GmbH * * Solutions for real time microcontroller applications * ********************************************************************** * * * (C) 2007 - 2008 SEGGER Microcontroller Systeme GmbH * * * * www.segger.com Support: support@segger.com * * * ********************************************************************** * * * TCP/IP stack for embedded applications * * * ********************************************************************** ---------------------------------------------------------------------File : IP_NI_Template.c Purpose : Network interface driver template -------- END-OF-HEADER --------------------------------------------*/ #include "IP_Int.h" /********************************************************************* * * _SetFilter * * Function description * Sets the MAC filter(s) * The stack tells the driver which addresses should go thru the filter. * The number of addresses can generally be unlimited. * In most cases, only one address is set. * However, if the NI is in multiple nets at the same time or if multicast is used, * multiple addresses can be set. * * Notes * (1) Procedure * In general, precise filtering is used as far as supported by the hardware. * If the more addresses need to be filtered than precise address filters are * available, then the hash filter is used. * Alternativly, the MAC can be switched to promiscuous mode for simple * implementations. */ static int _SetFilter(IP_NI_CMD_SET_FILTER_DATA * pFilter) { U32 v; U32 w; unsigned i; unsigned NumAddr; const U8 * pAddrData; NumAddr = pFilter->NumAddr; for (i = 0; i < NumAddr; i++) { pAddrData = *(&pFilter->pHWAddr + i); } return 0; // O.K. } /********************************************************************* * * _SendPacket * * Function description * Send the next packet in the send queue. * Function is called from 2 places: * - from a task via pfSendPacketIfTxIdle() in Driver structure * - from ISR when Tx is completed (TxInterrupt) */ static int _SendPacket(void) { U32 v; void * pPacket; unsigned NumBytes; UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 322 CHAPTER 15 IP_GetNextOutPacket(&pPacket, &NumBytes); Network interface drivers // Get information about next // packet in the Queue. 0 // means no packet in queue if (NumBytes == 0) { return 0; } IP_LOG((IP_MTYPE_DRIVER, "DRIVER: Sending packet: %d bytes", NumBytes)); // // Start send // return 0; } /********************************************************************* * * _ISR_Handler * * Function description * This is the interrupt service routine for the NI (EMAC). * It handles all interrupts (Rx, Tx, Error). * */ static void _ISR_Handler(void) { } /********************************************************************* * * _Init * * Function description * General init function of the driver. * Called by the stack in the init phase before any other driver function. */ static int _Init(unsigned Unit) { int r; r = _PHY_Init(Unit); if (r) { return 1; } // // TBD // return 0; // Configure the PHY } /********************************************************************* * * _SendPacketIfTxIdle * * Function description * Send the next packet in the send queue if transmitter is idle. * If transmitter is busy, nothing is done since the next packet is sent * automatically with Tx-interrupt. * Function is called from a task via function pointer in in driver structure. */ static int _SendPacketIfTxIdle(unsigned Unit) { // // TBD // return 0; } /********************************************************************* * * _GetPacketSize() * * Function description * Reads buffer descriptors in order to find out if a packet has been received. * Different error conditions are checked and handled. * Function is called from a task via function pointer in driver structure. * * Return value * Number of buffers used for the next packet. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 323 * 0 if no complete packet is available. */ static int _GetPacketSize(unsigned Unit) { // // TBD // return 0; } /********************************************************************* * * _ReadPacket * * Function description * Reads the first packet into the buffer. * NumBytes must be the correct number of bytes as retrieved by _GetPacketSize(); * Function is called from a task via function pointer in driver structure. * */ static int _ReadPacket(unsigned Unit, U8 *pDest, unsigned NumBytes) { // // TBD // return 0; } /********************************************************************* * * _Timer * * Function description * Timer function called by the Net task once per second. * Function is called from a task via function pointer in driver structure. */ static void _Timer(unsigned Unit) { // _UpdateLinkState(); } /********************************************************************* * * _Control * * Function description * Control function for various purposes. * Function is called from a task via function pointer in driver structure. * * Return value * -1: Command is not supported * !=-1: Command supported. Typically 0 means success, * but can also be a return value. */ static int _Control(unsigned Unit, int Cmd, void * p) { switch (Cmd) { case IP_NI_CMD_SET_FILTER: return _SetFilter((IP_NI_CMD_SET_FILTER_DATA*)p); case IP_NI_CMD_SET_BPRESSURE: // // TBD: Enable back pressure (if supported) and change return value to 0 // break; case IP_NI_CMD_CLR_BPRESSURE: // // TBD: Disable back pressure (if supported) and change return value to 0 // break; case IP_NI_CMD_GET_MAC_ADDR: break; case IP_NI_CMD_GET_CAPS: // // TBD: Retrieves the capabilites, which are a logical-or combination of // the IP_NI_CAPS (if any) // // { // int v; // // v = 0 // | IP_NI_CAPS_WRITE_IP_CHKSUM // Driver capable of inserting the // IP-checksum into an outgoing packet? UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 324 CHAPTER 15 // | IP_NI_CAPS_WRITE_UDP_CHKSUM // | IP_NI_CAPS_WRITE_TCP_CHKSUM // | IP_NI_CAPS_WRITE_ICMP_CHKSUM // | IP_NI_CAPS_CHECK_IP_CHKSUM // | IP_NI_CAPS_CHECK_UDP_CHKSUM // | IP_NI_CAPS_CHECK_TCP_CHKSUM // | IP_NI_CAPS_CHECK_ICMP_CHKSUM // // // // // // // // // // // // // // // // // // Network interface drivers Driver capable of inserting the UDP-checksum into an outgoing packet? Driver capable of inserting the TCP-checksum into an outgoing packet? Driver capable of inserting the ICMP-checksum into an outgoing packet? Driver capable of computing and comparing the IP-checksum of incoming packets? Driver capable of computing and comparing the UDP-checksum of an incoming packet? Driver capable of computing and comparing the TCP-checksum of an incoming packet? Driver capable of computing and comparing the ICMP-checksum of an incoming packet? // } // return v; break; case IP_NI_CMD_POLL: // // Poll MAC (typically once per ms) in cases where MAC does not // trigger an interrupt. // break; default: ; } return -1; } /********************************************************************* * * Public API struct * * This is the only public part of the driver. * All driver functions are called indirectly via this structure * */ const IP_HW_DRIVER IP_Driver_Template = { _Init, _SendPacketIfTxIdle, _GetPacketSize, _ReadPacket, _Timer, _Control }; /*************************** End of file ****************************/ UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 325 Chapter 16 Configuring embOS/IP embOS/IP can be used without changing any of the compile-time flags. All compiletime configuration flags are preconfigured with valid values, which match the requirements of most applications. Network interface drivers can be added at runtime. The default configuration of embOS/IP can be changed via compile-time flags which can be added to IP_Conf.h. IP_Conf.h is the main configuration file for the TCP/IP stack. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 326 CHAPTER 16 Configuring embOS/IP 16.1 Runtime configuration Every driver folder includes a configuration file with implementations of runtime configuration functions explained in this chapter. These functions can be customized. 16.1.1 IP_X_Configure() Description Helper function to prepare and configure the TCP/IP stack. Prototype void IP_X_Config (void); Additional information This function is called by the startup code of the TCP/IP stack from IP_Init(). Refer to IP_Init() on page 101 for more information. Example /********************************************************************* * * IP_X_Config * * Function description * This function is called by the IP stack during IP_Init(). * * Typical memory/buffer configurations: * Microcontroller system, minimum size optimized * #define ALLOC_SIZE 0x1000 // 4 kBytes RAM * mtu = 576; // 576 is minimum acc. to * // RFC, 1500 is max. for * // Ethernet. * IP_SetMTU(0, mtu); // Maximum Transmission * // Unit is 1500 for * // Ethernet by default. * IP_AddBuffers(4, 256); // Small buffers. * IP_AddBuffers(2, mtu + 16); // Big buffers. Size should * // be mtu + 16 bytes for * // Ethernet header (2 bytes * // type, 2 * 6 bytes MAC, * // 2 bytes padding). * IP_ConfTCPSpace(2 * (mtu - 40), 1 * (mtu - 40)); // Define TCP Tx and Rx * // window size. * * Microcontroller system, size optimized * #define ALLOC_SIZE 0x3000 // 12 kBytes RAM * mtu = 576; // 576 is minimum acc. to * // RFC, 1500 is max. for * // Ethernet. * IP_SetMTU(0, mtu); // Maximum Transmission * // Unit is 1500 for * // Ethernet by default. * IP_AddBuffers(8, 256); // Small buffers. * IP_AddBuffers(4, mtu + 16); // Big buffers. Size should * // be mtu + 16 bytes for * // Ethernet header (2 bytes * // type, 2 * 6 bytes MAC, * // 2 bytes padding). * IP_ConfTCPSpace(2 * (mtu - 40), 2 * (mtu - 40)); // Define TCP Tx and Rx * // window size. * * Microcontroller system, speed optimized or multiple connections * #define ALLOC_SIZE 0x6000 // 24 kBytes RAM * mtu = 1500; // 576 is minimum acc. to * // RFC, 1500 is max. for * // Ethernet. * IP_SetMTU(0, mtu); // Maximum Transmission * // Unit is 1500 for * // Ethernet by default. * IP_AddBuffers(12, 256); // Small buffers. * IP_AddBuffers(6, mtu + 16); // Big buffers. Size should * // be mtu + 16 bytes for * // Ethernet header (2 bytes * // type, 2 * 6 bytes MAC, UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 327 * * IP_ConfTCPSpace(3 * (mtu - 40), 3 * (mtu - 40)); * * * System with lots of RAM * #define ALLOC_SIZE 0x20000 * mtu = 1500; * * * IP_SetMTU(0, mtu); * * * IP_AddBuffers(50, 256); * IP_AddBuffers(50, mtu + 16); * * * * * IP_ConfTCPSpace(8 * (mtu - 40), 8 * (mtu - 40)); * */ void IP_X_Config(void) { int mtu; IP_AssignMemory(_aPool, sizeof(_aPool)); IP_AddEtherInterface(&IP_Driver_STR912); IP_SetHWAddr("\x00\x22\x33\x44\x55\x66"); // // // // // 2 bytes padding). // Define TCP Tx and Rx // window size. // // // // // // // // // // // // // // // 128 kBytes RAM 576 is minimum acc. to RFC, 1500 is max. for Ethernet. Maximum Transmission Unit is 1500 for Ethernet by default. Small buffers. Big buffers. Size should be mtu + 16 bytes for Ethernet header (2 bytes type, 2 * 6 bytes MAC, 2 bytes padding). Define TCP Tx and Rx window size. Assigning memory Add ethernet driver MAC addr: Needs to be unique for production units // // Use DHCP client or define IP address, subnet mask, // gateway address and DNS server according to the // requirements of your application. // IP_DHCPC_Activate(0, "TARGET", NULL, NULL); // IP_SetAddrMask(0xC0A805E6, 0xFFFF0000); // Assign IP addr. and subnet mask // IP_SetGWAddr(0, 0xC0A80201); // Set gateway address // IP_DNS_SetServer(0xCC98B84C); // Set DNS server address, // for example 204.152.184.76 // // Add protocols to the stack // IP_TCP_Add(); IP_UDP_Add(); IP_ICMP_Add(); // // Run-time configure buffers. // The default setup will do for most cases. // IP_AddBuffers(12, 256); // Small buffers. IP_AddBuffers(6, mtu + 16); // Big buffers. Size should be // mtu + 16 bytes for Ethernet // header (2 bytes type, 2 * 6 // bytes MAC, 2 bytes padding). IP_ConfTCPSpace(3 * (mtu - 40), 3 * (mtu - 40)); // Define the TCP Tx and Rx // window size. // // Define log and warn filter // Note: The terminal I/O emulation affects the timing // of your communication, since the debugger stops the target // for every terminal I/O output unless you use DCC! // IP_SetWarnFilter(0xFFFFFFFF); // 0xFFFFFFFF: Output all warnings. IP_SetLogFilter(IP_MTYPE_INIT // Output all messages from init | IP_MTYPE_LINK_CHANGE // Output a msg if link status changes | IP_MTYPE_DHCP // Output general DHCP status messages ); } 16.1.2 Driver handling IP_X_Config() is called at initialization of the TCP/IP stack. It is called by the IP stack during IP_Init(). IP_X_Config() should help to bundle the process of adding and configuring the driver. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 328 CHAPTER 16 Configuring embOS/IP 16.1.3 Memory and buffer assignment The total memory requirements of the TCP/IP stack can basically be computed as the sum of the following components: Description IP-Stack core Sockets UDP connection TCP/ connection ROM app. 200 bytes n * app. 200 bytes n * app. 100 bytes n * app. 200 bytes + RAM for TCP Window 16.1.3.1 RAM for TCP window The data for the TCP window is typically stored in large buffers. The number of large buffers required is typically: RxWindowSize / BigBufferSize This amount of buffers (and RAM for these buffers) is needed for every simultaneously active TCP connection, where "active" means sending & receiving data. 16.1.3.2 Required buffers Most of the RAM used by the stack is used for packet buffers. Packet buffers are used to hold incoming and outgoing packets and data in receive and transmit windows of TCP connections. Example configuration - Extremly small (4 kBytes) This configuration is the smallest available or at least very close. It is intended to be used on MCUs with very little RAM and can be used for applications which are designed for a very low amount of traffic. #define ALLOC_SIZE 0x1000 mtu = 576; IP_SetMTU(0, mtu); IP_AddBuffers(4, 256); IP_AddBuffers(2, mtu + 16); IP_ConfTCPSpace(2 * (mtu-40), 1 * (mtu-40)); // // // // // // // // // // // 4 kBytes RAM 576 is minimum acc. to RFC, 1500 is max. for Ethernet Maximum Transmission Unit is 1500 for ethernet by default Small buffers. Big buffers. Size should be mtu + 16 byte for ethernet header (2 bytes type, 2*6 bytes MAC, 2 bytes padding) Define TCP Tx and Rx window size Example configuration - Small (12 kBytes) This configuration is a small configuration intended to be used on MCUs with little RAM and can be used for applications which are designed for a medium amount of traffic. #define ALLOC_SIZE 0x3000 mtu = 576; IP_SetMTU(0, mtu); IP_AddBuffers(8, 256); IP_AddBuffers(4, mtu + 16); IP_ConfTCPSpace(2 * (mtu-40), 2 * (mtu-40)); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP // // // // // // // // // // // 12 kBytes RAM 576 is minimum acc. to RFC, 1500 is max. for Ethernet Maximum Transmission Unit is 1500 for ethernet by default Small buffers. Big buffers. Size should be mtu + 16 byte for ethernet header (2 bytes type, 2*6 bytes MAC, 2 bytes padding) Define TCP Tx and Rx window size (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 329 Example configuration - Normal (24 kBytes) This configuration is a typical configuration for many MCUs that have a fair amount of internal RAM. It can be used for applications which are designed for a higher amount of traffic and/or multiple client connections. #define ALLOC_SIZE 0x6000 mtu = 1500; IP_SetMTU(0, mtu); IP_AddBuffers(12, 256); IP_AddBuffers(6, mtu + 16); IP_ConfTCPSpace(3 * (mtu-40), 3 * (mtu-40)); // // // // // // // // // // // 24 kBytes RAM 576 is minimum acc. to RFC, 500 is max. for Ethernet Maximum Transmission Unit is 1500 for ethernet by default Small buffers. Big buffers. Size should be mtu + 16 byte for ethernet header (2 bytes type, 2*6 bytes MAC, 2 bytes padding) Define TCP Tx and Rx window size Example configuration - Large (128 kBytes) This configuration is a large configuration intended to be used on MCUs with many external RAM. It can be used for applications which are designed for a high amount of traffic and multiple client/server connections at the same time. #define ALLOC_SIZE 0x20000 mtu = 1500; IP_SetMTU(0, mtu); IP_AddBuffers(50, 256); IP_AddBuffers(50, mtu + 16); IP_ConfTCPSpace(8 * (mtu-40), 8 * (mtu-40)); UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP // // // // // // // // // // // 128 Kbytes RAM 576 is minimum acc. to RFC, 1500 is max. for Ethernet Maximum Transmission Unit is 1500 for ethernet by default Small buffers. Big buffers. Size should be mtu + 16 byte for ethernet header (2 bytes type, 2*6 bytes MAC, 2 bytes padding) Define TCP Tx and Rx window size (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 330 CHAPTER 16 Configuring embOS/IP 16.2 Compile-time configuration The following types of configuration macros exist: Binary switches "B" Switches can have a value of either 0 or 1, for deactivated and activated respectively. Actually, anything other than 0 works, but 1 makes it easier to read a configuration file. These switches can enable or disable a certain functionality or behavior. Switches are the simplest form of configuration macros. Numerical values "N" Numerical values are used somewhere in the code in place of a numerical constant. A typical example is the configuration of the sector size of a storage medium. Function replacements "F" Macros can basically be treated like regular functions although certain limitations apply, as a macro is still put into the code as simple text replacement. Function replacements are mainly used to add specific functionality to a module which is highly hardware-dependent. This type of macro is always declared using brackets (and optional parameters). 16.2.1 Compile-time configuration switches Type Symbolic name N IP_IS_BIGENDIAN N IP_DEBUG F IP_CKSUM F IP_MEMCPY F IP_MEMSET Default Description System configuration macros Macro to define if a big endian tar-get is used. Debug macros Macro to define the debug level of the embOS/IP build. Refer to 0 Debug level on page 331 for a description of the different debug level. Optimization macros Macro to define an optimized checksum routine to speed up the stack. An optimized checksum rouIP_cksum tine is typically implemented in (C- routine in IP assembly language. stack) Optimized versions for the GNU, IAR and ADS compilers are supplied. Macro to define an optimized memcpy routine to speed up the memcpy stack. An optimized memcpy rou(C-routine in tine is typically implemented in standard Cassembly language. library) Optimized version for the IAR compiler is supplied. Macro to define an optimized memset memset routine to speed up the (C-routine in stack. An optimized memset roustandard Ctine is typically implemented in library) assembly language. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 331 Type F F Symbolic name Default IP_MEMMOVE memmove (C-routine in standard Clibrary) IP_MEMCMP memcmp (C-routine in standard Clibrary) Description Macro to define an optimized memmove routine to speed up the stack. An optimized memmove routine is typically implemented in assembly language. Macro to define an optimized memcmp routine to speed up the stack. An optimized memcmp routine is typically implemented in assembly language. 16.2.2 Debug level embOS/IP can be configured to display debug information at higher debug levels to locate a problem (Error) or potential problem. To display information, embOS/IP uses the logging routines (see chapter Debugging on page 541). These routines can be blank, they are not required for the functionality of embOS/IP. In a target system, they are typically not required in a release (production) build, since a production build typically uses a lower debug level. If (IP_DEBUG == 0): used for release builds. Includes no debug options. If (IP_DEBUG == 1): IP_PANIC() is mapped to IP_Panic(). If (IP_DEBUG >= 2): IP_PANIC() is mapped to IP_Panic() and logging support is activated. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 332 UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP CHAPTER 16 Configuring embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 333 Chapter 17 Web server (Add-on) The embOS/IP web server is an optional extension to embOS/IP. The web server can be used with embOS/IP or with a different TCP/IP stack. All functions that are required to add a web server task to your application are described in this chapter. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 334 CHAPTER 17 Web server (Add-on) 17.1 embOS/IP web server The embOS/IP web server is an optional extension which adds the HTTP protocol to the stack. It combines a maximum of performance with a small memory footprint. The web server allows an embedded system to present web pages with dynamically generated content. It comes with all features typically required by embedded systems: multiple connections, authentication, forms and low RAM usage. RAM usage has been kept to a minimum by smart buffer handling. The web server implements the relevant parts of the following Request For Comments (RFC). RFC# Description HTTP - Hypertext Direct download: HTTP - Hypertext Direct download: [RFC 1945] [RFC 2616] Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.0 ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc1945.txt Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.1 ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc2616.txt The following table shows the contents of the embOS/IP web server root directory: Directory Content Application\ Contains the example application to run the web server with embOS/IP. Config Contains the web server configuration file. Refer to Configuration on page 355 for detailed information. Inc Contains the required include files. IP Contains the web server sources, IP_Webserver.c, IP_Webserver.h and IP_UTIL_BASE64.c, IP_UTIL.h. IP\FS\ Contains the sources for the file system abstraction layer and the read-only file system. Refer to File system abstraction layer on page 564 for detailed information. Windows\Webserver\ Contains the source, the project files and an executable to run embOS/IP web server on a Microsoft Windows host. Refer to Using the web server sample on page 339 for detailed information. Supplied directory structure of embOS/IP web server package UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 335 17.2 Feature list * * * * * * * * * * * Low memory footprint. Dynamic web pages (Server Side Includes). Authentication supported. Forms: POST and GET support. Multiple connections supported. r/o file system included. HTML to C converter included. Independent of the file system: any file system can be used. Independent of the TCP/IP stack: any stack with sockets can be used. Demo with authentication, various forms, dynamic pages included. Project for executable on PC for Microsoft Visual Studio included. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 336 CHAPTER 17 Web server (Add-on) 17.3 Requirements TCP/IP stack The embOS/IP web server requires a TCP/IP stack. It is optimized for embOS/IP, but any RFC-compliant TCP/IP stack can be used. The shipment includes a Win32 simulation, which uses the standard Winsock API and an implementation which uses the socket API of embOS/IP. Multi tasking The web server needs to run as a separate thread. Therefore, a multi tasking system is required to use the embOS/IP web server. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 337 17.4 HTTP backgrounds It is a communication protocol originally designed to transfer information via hypertext pages. The development of HTTP is coordinated by the IETF (Internet Engineering Task Force) and the W3C (World Wide Web Consortium). The current protocol version is 1.1. Application layer HTTP Transport layer TCP Network layer IP Link layer Ethernet (IEEE 802.3), ... 17.4.1 HTTP communication basics HTTP is a challenge and response protocol. A client initiates a TCP connection to the web server and sends a HTTP request. A HTTP request starts with a method token. [RFC 2616] defines 8 method tokens. The method token indicates the method to be performed on the requested resource. embOS/IP web server supports all methods which are typically required by an embedded web server. HTTP method GET HEAD POST Description The GET method means that it retrieves whatever information is identified by the Request-URI. The HEAD method means that it retrieves the header of the content which is identified by the Request-URI. The POST method submits data to be processed to the identified resource. The data is included in the body of the request. Table 17.1: Supported HTTP methods The following example shows parts of a HTTP session, where a client (for example, 192.168.1.75) asks the embOS/IP web server for the hypertext page example.html. The request is followed by a blank line, so that the request ends with a double newline, each in the form of a carriage return followed by a line feed. GET /example.html HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.1.75 The first line of every response message is the Status-Line, consisting of the protocol version followed by a numeric status code. The Status-Line is followed by the content-type, the server, expiration and the transfer-encoding. The server response ends with an empty line, followed by length of content that should be transferred. The length indicates the length of the web page in bytes. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 338 CHAPTER 17 Web server (Add-on) HTTP/1.1 200 OK Content-Type: text/html Server: embOS/IP Expires: THU, 26 OCT 1995 00:00:00 GMT Transfer-Encoding: chunked A3 Thereafter, the web server sends the requested hypertext page to the client. The zero at the end of the web page followed by an empty line signalizes that the transmission of the requested web page is complete. embOS/IP examples Website: example.htm
0 17.4.2 HTTP status codes The first line of a HTTP response is the Status-Line. It consists of the used protocol version, a status code and a short textual description of the Status-Code. The StatusCode element is a 3-digit integer result code of the attempt to understand and satisfy the request. The first digit of the Status-Code defines the class of response. The last two digits do not have any categorization role. There are 5 values for the first digit: * * * * * 1xx: 2xx: 3xx: 4xx: 5xx: Informational - Request received, continuing process. Success - The action was successfully received, understood, and accepted. Redirection - Further action must be taken in order to complete the request. Client Error - The request contains bad syntax or cannot be fulfilled. Server Error - The server failed to fulfill an apparently valid request. Refer to [RFC 2616] for a complete list of defined status-codes. embOS/IP web server supports a subset of the defined HTTP status codes. The following status codes are implemented: Status code 200 401 404 501 503 Description OK. The request has succeeded. Unauthorized. The request requires user authentication. Not found. The server has not found anything matching the Request-URI. Not implemented. The server does not support the HTTP method. Service unavailable. The server is currently unable to handle the request due to a temporary overloading of the server. Table 17.2: embOS/IP status codes UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 339 17.5 Using the web server sample Ready to use examples for Microsoft Windows and embOS/IP are supplied. If you use another TCP/IP stack, the sample OS_IP_Webserver.c has to be adapted. The web server itself does not handle multiple connections. This is part of the application and is included in the OS_IP_Webserver.c sample. The sample application opens a port which listens on port 80 until an incoming connection is detected in a parent task that accepts new connections (or rejects them if no more connections can be accepted). For each accepted client connection, the parent task creates a child task running IP_WEBS_Process() in a seperated context that will then process the request of the connected client (for example a browser). This way the parent task is ready to handle further incoming connections on port 80. Therefore the sample uses n client connections + one for the parent task. Some browsers may open multiple connections and do not even intend to close the connection. They rather keep the connections open for further data that might be requested. To give other clients a chance, a special handling is implemented in the web server. The embOS/IP web server has two functions for processing a connection in a child task: * * IP_WEBS_Process(), that allows a connection to stay open even after all data has been sent from the target. The connection will stay open as long as the client does not close it. IP_WEBS_ProcessLast(), that will close the connection once the target has sent all data requested. This is used by the web server sample for the last free connection available. This ensures that at least one connection will be available after it has been served to accept further clients. In addition to available connections that can be served directly, a feature called "backlogging" can be used. This means additional connections will be accepted (SYN/ACK is sent from target) but not yet processed. They will be processed as soon as a free connection becomes available once a child task has served the clients request and has been closed. Connections in backlog will be kept active until the client side sends a reset due to a possible timeout in the client. The example application uses a read-only file system to make web pages available. Refer to File system abstraction layer on page 564 and File system abstraction layer on page 564 for detailed information about the read-only file system. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 340 CHAPTER 17 Web server (Add-on) 17.5.1 Using the Windows sample If you have MS Visual C++ 6.00 or any later version available, you will be able to work with a Windows sample project using embOS/IP web server. If you do not have the Microsoft compiler, an precompiled executable of the web server is also supplied. Building the sample program Open the workspace Start_Webserver.dsw with MS Visual Studio (for example, double-clicking it). There is no further configuration necessary. You should be able to build the application without any error or warning message. The server uses the IP address of the host PC on which it runs. Open a web browser and connect by entering the IP address of the host (127.0.0.1) to connect to the web server. 17.5.2 Running the web server example on target hardware The embOS/IP web server sample application should always be the first step to check the proper function of the web server with your target hardware. Add all source files located in the following directories (and their subdirectories) to your project and update the include path: * * * * * * Application Config Inc IP IP\IP_FS\FS_RO\ IP\IP_FS\FS_RO\Generated\ It is recommended that you keep the provided folder structure. The sample application can be used on the most targets without the need for changing any of the configuration flags. The server processes up to three connections using the default configuration. Note: Three connections mean that the target can handle up to three targets in parallel, if every target uses only one connection. Because a single web browser often attempts to open more then one connection to a web server to request the files (.gif, .jpeg, etc.) which are included in the requested web page, the number of possible parallel connected targets is less than the number of possible connections. Every connection is handled in an separate task. Therefore, the web server uses up to four tasks in the default configuration, one task which listens on port 80 and accepts connections and three tasks to process the accepted connections. To modify the number of connections, only the macro MAX_CONNECTIONS has to be modified. The supplied sample web pages index.htm, embos.htm and stats.htm include dynamic content, refer to Common Gateway Interface (CGI) on page 342 for detailed information about the implementation of dynamic content. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 341 17.5.3 Changing the file system type By default, the web server uses the supplied read-only file system. If a real file system like emFile should be used to store the web pages, you have to modify the function _WebServerChildTask() of the example OS_IP_Webserver.c. /********************************************************************* * * _WebServerChildTask * */ static void _WebServerChildTask(void * Context) { long Sock; int Opt; _pFS_API = &IP_FS_ReadOnly; Sock = (long)Context; Opt = 1; setsockopt(Sock, SOL_SOCKET, SO_KEEPALIVE, &Opt, sizeof(Opt)); if (_ConnectCnt < MAX_CONNECTIONS) { IP_WEBS_Process(_Send, _Recv, Context, _pFS_API, &_Application); } else { IP_WEBS_ProcessLast(_Send, _Recv, Context, _pFS_API, &_Application); } _closesocket(Sock); _AddToConnectCnt(-1); OS_Terminate(0); } The usage of the read-only file system is configured with the following line: _pFS_API = &IP_FS_ReadOnly; To use emFile as file system for your web server application, add the emFile abstraction layer IP_FS_FS.c to your project and change the line to: _pFS_API = &IP_FS_FS; Refer to File system abstraction layer on page 564 and File system abstraction layer on page 564 for detailed information about the emFile and read-only file system abstraction layer. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 342 CHAPTER 17 Web server (Add-on) 17.6 Dynamic content embos/IP supports two different approaches to implement dynamic content in your web server application. A Common Gateway Interface (CGI) like interface for static HTML pages with dynamic elements and virtual files which are completely generated from the application. 17.6.1 Common Gateway Interface (CGI) A Common Gateway Interface (CGI) like interface is used to implement dynamic content in web pages. Every web page will be parsed by the server each time a request is received. The server searches the web page for a special tag. In the default configuration, the searched tag starts . The tag will be analyzed and the parameter will be extracted. This parameter specifies a serverside command and will be given to the user application, which can handle the command. The following screenshot shows the example page index.htm. The HTML source for the page includes the following line: When the web page is requested, the server parses the tag and the parameter Counter is searched for in an array of structures of type WEBS_CGI. The structure includes a string to identify the command and a pointer to the function which should be called if the parameter is found. typedef struct { const char * sName; // e.g. "Counter" void (*pf)(WEBS_OUTPUT * pOutput, const char * sParameters, const char * sValue); } WEBS_CGI; In the example, Counter is a valid parameter and the function _callback_ExecCounter will be called. You need to implement the WEBS_CGI array and the callback functions in your application. static const WEBS_CGI _aCGI[] = { {"Counter" , _callback_ExecCounter }, {"GetOSInfo" , _callback_ExecGetOSInfo}, {"GetIPAddr" , _callback_ExecGetIPAddr}, {NULL} }; UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 343 ExecCounter() is a simple example of how to use the CGI feature. It returns a string that includes the value of a variable which is incremented with every call to ExecCounter(). void ExecCounter( WEBS_OUTPUT * pOutput, const char * sParameters, const char * sValue ) { char ac[40]; static char Cnt = 1; sprintf(ac, "You are visitor no.: %d", Cnt); IP_WEBS_SendString(pOutput, ac); Cnt++; } If the web page includes the CGI tag followed by an unknown command (for example, a typo like COounter instead of Counter in the source code of the web page) an error message will be sent to the client. 17.6.1.1 Add new CGI functions to your web server application To define new CGI functions, three things have to be done. 1. Add a new command name which should be used as tag to the WEBS_CGI structure. For example: UserCGI static const WEBS_CGI _aCGI[] = { {"Counter" , _callback_ExecCounter }, {"GetOSInfo" , _callback_ExecGetOSInfo}, {"GetIPAddr" , _callback_ExecGetIPAddr}, {"UserCGI" , _callback_ExecUserCGI }, {NULL} }; 2. Implement the new function in your application source code. void _callback_ExecUserCGI( WEBS_OUTPUT * pOutput, const char * sParameters const char * sValue ) { /* Add application code here */ } 3. Add the new tag to the source code of your web page: UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 344 CHAPTER 17 Web server (Add-on) 17.6.2 Virtual files embOS/IP supports virtual files. A virtual file is not a real file which is stored in the used file system. It is a function which is called instead. The function generates the content of a file and sends it to the client. The web server checks the extension of all requested files, the extension .cgi is by default used for virtual files. To change the extension that is used to detect a virtual file, refer to IP_WEBS_SetFileInfoCallback() on page 365 for detailed information. The embOS/IP web server comes with an example (CallVirtualFile.htm) that requests a virtual file. The sample web page contains a form with two input test fields, named FirstName and LastName, and a button to transmit the data to the server. When the button on the web page is pressed, the file Send.cgi is requested. The embOS/IP Web server recognizes the extension .cgi, checks if a virtual file with the name Send.cgi is defined and calls the defined function. The function in the example is _callback_SendCGI and gets the string FirstName=Foo&LastName=Bar as parameter. typedef struct { const char * sName; void (*pf)(WEBS_OUTPUT * pOutput, const char * sParameters); } WEBS_VFILES; In the example, Send.cgi is a valid URI and the function _callback_SendCGI will be called. static const WEBS_VFILES _aVFiles[] = { {"Send.cgi", _callback_SendCGI }, NULL }; The virtual file Send.cgi gets two parameters. The strings entered in the input fields Firstname and LastName are transmitted with the URI. For example, you enter Foo in the first name field and Bar for last name and push the button. The browser will transmit the following string to our web server: Send.cgi?FirstName=Foo&LastName=Bar You can parse the string and use it in the way you want to. In the example we parse the string and output the values on a web page which is build from the function _callback_SendCGI(). static void _callback_SendCGI(WEBS_OUTPUT * pOutput, const char * sParameters) { char aPara0[32]; char aValue0[32]; char aPara1[32]; char aValue1[32]; int r; UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 345 IP_WEBS_SendString(pOutput, "CGI Sample"); IP_WEBS_SendString(pOutput, ""); IP_WEBS_SendString(pOutput, "
CGI Sample
First name: "); r = IP_WEBS_GetParaValue(sParameters, 0, aPara0, sizeof(aPara0), aValue0, sizeof(aValue0)); if (r == 0) { IP_WEBS_SendString(pOutput, aValue0); } IP_WEBS_SendString(pOutput, "
Last name: "); r = IP_WEBS_GetParaValue(sParameters, 1, aPara1, sizeof(aPara1), aValue1, sizeof(aValue1)); if (r == 0) { IP_WEBS_SendString(pOutput, aValue1); } IP_WEBS_SendString(pOutput, "
"); IP_WEBS_SendString(pOutput, "
Back www.segger.com "); } The output of _callback_SendCGI() should be similar to: UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 346 CHAPTER 17 Web server (Add-on) 17.7 Authentication "HTTP/1.0", includes the specification for a Basic Access Authentication scheme. The basic authentication scheme is a non-secure method of filtering unauthorized access to resources on an HTTP server, because the user name and password are passed over the network as clear text. It is based on the assumption that the connection between the client and the server can be regarded as a trusted carrier. As this is not generally true on an open network, the basic authentication scheme should be used accordingly. The basic access authentication scheme is described in: RFC# [RFC 2617] Description HTTP Authentication: Basic and Digest Access Authentication Direct download: ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc2617.txt The "basic" authentication scheme is based on the model that the client must authenticate itself with a user-ID and a password for each realm. The realm value should be considered an opaque string which can only be compared for equality with other realms on that server. The server will service the request only if it can validate the user-ID and password for the protection space of the Request-URI. There are no optional authentication parameters. Upon receipt of an unauthorized request for a URI within the protection space, the server should respond with a challenge like the following: WWW-Authenticate: Basic realm="Embedded web server" where "embOS/IP embedded web server" is the string assigned by the server to identify the protection space of the Request-URI. To receive authorization, the client sends the user-ID and password, separated by a single colon (":") character, within a base64 encoded string in the credentials. If the user agent wishes to send the user-ID "user" and password "pass", it would use the following header field: Authorization: Basic dXNlcjpwYXNz UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 347 17.7.1 Authentication example The client requests a resource for which authentication is required: GET /conf/Authen.htm HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.1.75 The server answers the request with a "401 Unauthorized" status page. The header of the 401 error page includes an additional line WWW-Authenticate. It includes the realm for which the proper user name and password should be transmitted from the client (for example, a web browser). HTTP/1.1 401 Unauthorized Date: Mon, 04 Feb 2008 17:00:44 GMT Server: embOS/IP Accept-Ranges: bytes Content-Length: 695 Connection: close Content-Type: text/html X-Pad: avoid browser bug WWW-Authenticate: Basic realm="embOS/IP embedded web server" 401 Unauthorized 401 Unauthorized
Browser not authentication-capable or authentication failed. The client interprets the header and opens a dialog box to enter the user name and password combination for the realm of the resource. Note: The embOS/IP web server example always uses the following user name and the password combination: User Name: user - Password: pass Enter the proper user name/password combination for the requested realm and confirm with the OK button. The client encodes the user name/password combination to a base64 encoded string and requests the resource again. The request header is enhanced by the following line: Authorization: Basic dXNlcjpwYXNz GET /conf/Authen.htm HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.1.75 Authorization: Basic dXNlcjpwYXNz The server decodes the user name/password combination and checks if the decoded string matches to the defined user name/password combination of the realm. If the strings are identical, the server delivers the page. If the strings are not identical, the server answers again with a "401 Unauthorized" status page. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 348 CHAPTER 17 Web server (Add-on) HTTP/1.1 200 OK Content-Type: text/html Server: embOS/IP Expires: THU, 26 OCT 1995 00:00:00 GMT Transfer-Encoding: chunked 200
web server configuration 0 17.7.2 Configuration of the authentication The embOS/IP web server checks the access rights of every resource before returning it. The user can define different realms to separate different parts of the web server resources. An array of WEBS_ACCESS_CONTROL structures has to be implemented in the user application. Refer to Structure WEBS_ACCESS_CONTROL on page 394 for detailed information about the elements of the WEBS_ACCESS_CONTROL structure. If no authentication should be used, the array includes only one entry for the root path. WEBS_ACCESS_CONTROL _aAccessControl[] = { { "/", NULL, NULL }, 0 }; To define a realm "conf", an additional WEBS_ACCESS CONTROL entry has to be implemented. WEBS_ACCESS_CONTROL _aAccessControl[] = { { "/conf/", "Login for configuration", "user:pass" }, { "/", NULL, NULL }, 0 }; The string "Login for configuration" defines the realm. "user:pass" is the user name/password combination stored in one string. UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 349 17.8 Form handling The embOS/IP web server supports both POST and GET actions to receive form data from a client. POST submits data to be processed to the identified resource. The data is included in the body of the request. GET is normally only used to requests a resource, but it is also possible to use GET for actions in web applications. Data processing on server side might create a new resource or update existing resources or both. Every HTML form consists of input items like textfields, buttons, checkboxes, etc. Each of these input items has a name tag. When the user places data in these items in the form, that information is encoded into the form data. Form data is a stream of = pairs separated by the "&" character. The value each of the input item is given by the user is called the value. The = pairs are URL encoded, which means that spaces are changed into "+" and special characters are encoded into hexadecimal values. Refer to [RFC 1738] for detailed information about URL encoding. The parsing and decoding of form data is handled by the embOS/IP web server. Thereafter, the server calls a callback function with the decoded and parsed strings as parameters. The responsibility to implement the callback function is on the user side. Valid characters for CGI function names: * * * * A-Z a-z 0-9 . _ - Valid characters for CGI parameter values: * * * * * A-Z a-z 0-9 All URL encoded characters . _ - *()!$\ UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 350 CHAPTER 17 Web server (Add-on) 17.8.1 Simple form processing sample The following example shows the handling of the output of HTML forms with your web server application. The example web page ExampleGET.htm implements a form with three inputs, two text fields and one button. The HTML code of the web page as it is added to the server is listed below: embOS/IP web server form example The action field of the form can specify a resource that the browser should reference when it sends back filled-in form data. If the action field defines no resource, the current resource will be requested again. If you request the web page from the embOS/IP web server and check the source of the page in your web browser, the CGI parts "" and "" will be executed before the page will be transmitted to the server, so that in the example the values of the value= fields will be empty strings. The HTML code of the web page as seen by the web browser is listed below: embOS/IP web server form example UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 351 To start form processing, you have to fill in the FirstName and the LastName field and click the Send button. In the example, the browser sends a GET request for the resource referenced in the form and appends the form data to the resource name as an URL encoded string. The form data is separated from the resource name by "?". Every = pair is separated by "&". For example, if you type in the FirstName field John and Doe in the LastName field and confirm the input by clicking the Send button, the following string will be transmitted to the server and shown in the address bar of the browser. http://192.168.1.230/ExampleGET.htm?FirstName=John&LastName=Doe Note: If you use POST as HTTP method, the name>= pairs are not shown in the address bar of the browser. The = pairs are in this case included in the entity body. The embOS/IP web server parses the form data. The field specifies the name of a CGI function which should be called to process the field. The server checks therefore if an entry is available in the WEBS_CGI array. static const WEBS_CGI _aCGI[] = { {"FirstName", _callback_ExecFirstName}, {"LastName", _callback_ExecLastName }, {NULL} }; If an entry can be found, the specified callback function will be called. The callback function for the parameter FirstName is defined as follow: /********************************************************************* * * Static data * ********************************************************************** */ static char _acFirstName[12]; /********************************************************************* * * _callback_FirstName */ static void _callback_ExecFirstName( WEBS_OUTPUT * pOutput, const char * sParameters, const char * sValue ) { if (sValue == NULL) { IP_WEBS_SendString(pOutput, _acFirstName); } else { _CopyString(_acFirstName, sValue, sizeof(_acFirstName)); } } The function returns a string if sValue is NULL. If sValue is defined, it will be written into a character array. Because HTTP transmission methods GET and POST only transmit the value of filled input fields, the same function can be used to output a stored value of an input field or to set a new value. The example web page shows after entering and transmitting the input the new values of FirstName and LastName as value in the input fields. The source of the web page as seen by the web browser is listed below: UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 352 CHAPTER 17 Web server (Add-on) embOS/IP web server form example UM07001 User & Reference Guide for embOS/IP (c) 2007 - 2014 SEGGER Microcontroller GmbH & Co. KG 353 17.9 File upload The embOS/IP web server supports file uploads from the client. For this to be possible a real file system has to be used and the define WEBS_SUPPORT_UPLOAD has to be defined to "1". From the application side uploading a file in general is the same as for other form data as described in Form handling on page 349. For file uploading a
The action field of the form can specify a resource that the browser should reference when it has finished handling the file upload. If the action field defines no resource, the current resource will be requested again. To upload a file, you have to select a file by using the browse button and select a file to upload and click the Send button. In the example, the browser sends a POST request for the resource referenced in the form and appends the form and file data in an encoded string. The embOS/IP web server parses additional form data passed besides the file to be uploaded. This works the same as handling form data described in Form handling on page 349. The action parameter of the